blob: dddb07e6b1dae407022fe17c789f1f04d7b3a90d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaueab1dc62013-06-17 15:10:25 +02007 2013/06/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
160everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
161established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
162sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
163while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
164another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
165sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
166http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
167mode.
168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
1701.2. HTTP request
171-----------------
172
173First, let's consider this HTTP request :
174
175 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100176 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
178 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
179 3 User-agent: my small browser
180 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
181 5 Accept: image/png
182
183
1841.2.1. The Request line
185-----------------------
186
187Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
188
189 - a METHOD : GET
190 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
191 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
192
193All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
194which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
195followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
196is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
197desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
198the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
199
200The URI itself can have several forms :
201
202 - A "relative URI" :
203
204 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
207 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
208
209 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
210
211 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
212
213 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
214 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
215 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
216 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
217 must accept this form too.
218
219 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
220 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
221 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
224 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
225 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
226 other protocols too.
227
228In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
229mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
230on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
231It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
232specific to the language, framework or application in use.
233
234
2351.2.2. The request headers
236--------------------------
237
238The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
239beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
240an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
241Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
242values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
243encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
244the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
245define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
246
247Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
248their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
249"Connection:" header).
250
251The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
252that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
253is one valid form of empty line.
254
255Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
256headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
257about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
258application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
259
260Important note:
261 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
262 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
263 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
264 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
265
266
2671.3. HTTP response
268------------------
269
270An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
271messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
272
273 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100274 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200275 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
276 2 Content-length: 350
277 3 Content-Type: text/html
278
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200279As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
280codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
281response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100282continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
283the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
284following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
285sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
286(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
287correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
288such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
289state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
290over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
291if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
292information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
2951.3.1. The Response line
296------------------------
297
298Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
299
300 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
301 - a status code : 200
302 - a reason : OK
303
304The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200305 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
307 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
308 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
309 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
310
311Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
314messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
315or "Authentication Required".
316
317Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
318
319 Code When / reason
320 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
321 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
322 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
323 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100324 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 400 for an invalid or too large request
327 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
328 accessing the stats page)
329 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
330 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
331 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
332 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
333 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
334 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
335 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
336 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
337 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
338
339The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3404.2).
341
342
3431.3.2. The response headers
344---------------------------
345
346Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
347the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
348details.
349
350
3512. Configuring HAProxy
352----------------------
353
3542.1. Configuration file format
355------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200356
357HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
358
359 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
360 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
361 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
362 "frontend" and "backend".
363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
365referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
366delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368escaped by doubling them.
369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370
3712.2. Time format
372----------------
373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100374Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
376otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
377numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
378for every keyword. Supported units are :
379
380 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
381 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
382 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
383 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
384 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
385 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
386
387
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003882.3. Examples
389-------------
390
391 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
392 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
393 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
394 global
395 daemon
396 maxconn 256
397
398 defaults
399 mode http
400 timeout connect 5000ms
401 timeout client 50000ms
402 timeout server 50000ms
403
404 frontend http-in
405 bind *:80
406 default_backend servers
407
408 backend servers
409 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
410
411
412 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
413 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
414 global
415 daemon
416 maxconn 256
417
418 defaults
419 mode http
420 timeout connect 5000ms
421 timeout client 50000ms
422 timeout server 50000ms
423
424 listen http-in
425 bind *:80
426 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
427
428
429Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
430
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100431 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432
433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004343. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200435--------------------
436
437Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
438are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
439of them have command-line equivalents.
440
441The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
442
443 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200444 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - daemon
448 - gid
449 - group
450 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100451 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - nbproc
453 - pidfile
454 - uid
455 - ulimit-n
456 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200457 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200458 - node
459 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100460 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100461
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200462 * Performance tuning
463 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200464 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100465 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100466 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100467 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200468 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - noepoll
470 - nokqueue
471 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200473 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200474 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200475 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100476 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100477 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200478 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100479 - tune.maxaccept
480 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200481 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200482 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100483 - tune.rcvbuf.client
484 - tune.rcvbuf.server
485 - tune.sndbuf.client
486 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100487 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100488 - tune.ssl.lifetime
489 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100490 - tune.zlib.memlevel
491 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100492
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200493 * Debugging
494 - debug
495 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200496
497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004983.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499------------------------------------
500
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200501ca-base <dir>
502 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200503 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
504 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506chroot <jail dir>
507 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
508 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
509 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
510 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
511 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
512 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100513
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100514cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
515 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
516 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
517 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
518 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
519 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
520 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
521 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
522 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
523 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
524 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
525 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
526 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
527 they overlap.
528
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200529crt-base <dir>
530 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
531 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
532 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
533
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200534daemon
535 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
536 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
537 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
538
539gid <number>
540 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
541 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
542 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100543 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
544 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100546
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547group <group name>
548 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
549 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100550
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200551log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
553 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100554 configured with "log global".
555
556 <address> can be one of:
557
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100558 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100559 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
560 port).
561
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100562 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
563 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
564 port).
565
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100566 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
567 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
568 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
569 writeable).
570
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100571 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
572 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
573 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
574 in Bourne shell.
575
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577
578 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
579 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
580 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
581
582 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200583 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
584 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
585 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
586 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
587 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
588 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200590 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100592log-send-hostname [<string>]
593 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
594 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
595 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
596 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
597 the logs.
598
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000599log-tag <string>
600 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
601 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
602 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
603 running on the same host.
604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605nbproc <number>
606 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
607 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
608 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
609 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
610 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
611
612pidfile <pidfile>
613 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
614 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
615 starting the process. See also "daemon".
616
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100617stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200618 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
619 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
620 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
621 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
622 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
623 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
624 the number of processes used.
625
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200626stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
627 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
628 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
629 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
630 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200631
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200632 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
633 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
634 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200635
636stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
637 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
638 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100639 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200640
641stats maxconn <connections>
642 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
643 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645uid <number>
646 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
647 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
648 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
649 one. See also "gid" and "user".
650
651ulimit-n <number>
652 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
653 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
654 option.
655
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100656unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
657 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
658
659 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
660 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
661 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
662 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
663 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
664 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
665 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
666 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
667 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
668 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200670user <user name>
671 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
672 See also "uid" and "group".
673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200674node <name>
675 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
676
677 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
678 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
679 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
680 traffic.
681
682description <text>
683 Add a text that describes the instance.
684
685 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
686 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
687 "<" and ">" characters.
688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006903.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691-----------------------
692
693maxconn <number>
694 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
695 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
696 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
697 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
698
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200699maxconnrate <number>
700 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
701 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
702 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
703 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
704 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
705 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
706 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
707 fairness.
708
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100709maxcomprate <number>
710 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
711 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
712 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
713 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
714 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
715 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
716 default value.
717
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100718maxcompcpuusage <number>
719 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
720 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
721 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
722 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
723 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
724 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
725 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
726 process down and from introducing high latencies.
727
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100728maxpipes <number>
729 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
730 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
731 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
732 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
733 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
734 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
735
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200736maxsslconn <number>
737 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
738 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
739 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
740 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
741 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
742 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
743 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
744
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100745maxzlibmem <number>
746 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
747 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
748 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100749 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
750 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
751 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
752
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753noepoll
754 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
755 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100756 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200757
758nokqueue
759 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
760 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
761 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
762
763nopoll
764 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
765 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100766 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100767 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100769nosplice
770 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
771 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
772 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100773 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100774 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
775 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
776 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
777 "option splice-response".
778
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200779spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
780 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
781 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
782 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
783 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
784 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
785
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200786tune.bufsize <number>
787 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
788 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
789 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
790 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
791 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
792 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
793 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
794 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400795 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
796 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
797 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200798
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200799tune.chksize <number>
800 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
801 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
802 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
803 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
804 checks whenever possible.
805
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100806tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
807 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
808 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
809 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
810 this value. The default value is 1.
811
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100812tune.http.cookielen <number>
813 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
814 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
815 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
816 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
817 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
818 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
819 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
820 to change this value.
821
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200822tune.http.maxhdr <number>
823 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
824 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
825 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
826 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
827 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
828 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
829 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
830 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
831 limit too high.
832
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100833tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100834 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
835 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
836 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
837 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
838 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
839 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
840 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
841 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
842 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
843 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100844
845tune.maxpollevents <number>
846 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
847 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
848 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
849 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
850 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
851
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200852tune.maxrewrite <number>
853 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
854 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
855 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
856 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
857 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
858 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
859 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
860 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
861 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
862 bufsize.
863
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200864tune.pipesize <number>
865 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
866 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
867 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
868 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
869 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
870 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
871
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100872tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
873tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
874 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
875 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
876 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
877 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
878 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
879 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
880 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
881
882tune.sndbuf.client <number>
883tune.sndbuf.server <number>
884 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
885 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
886 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
887 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
888 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
889 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
890 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
891 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
892 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
893 notifying haproxy again.
894
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100895tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100896 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
897 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
898 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
899 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
900 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
901 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
902 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
903 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
904 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100905 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
906 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100907
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100908tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
909 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
910 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
911 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
912 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
913 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
914 being used for too long.
915
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100916tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
917 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
918 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
919 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
920 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
921 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
922 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
923 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
924 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
925 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
926 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
927 best value.
928
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100929tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
930 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
931 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
932 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
933 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
934 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
935
936tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
937 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
938 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
939 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
940 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009423.3. Debugging
943--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200944
945debug
946 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
947 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
948 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
949 system startup.
950
951quiet
952 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
953 line argument "-q".
954
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009563.4. Userlists
957--------------
958It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
959http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
960it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
961
962userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100963 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100964 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
965
966group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100967 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100968 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
969 proceeded by "users" keyword.
970
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100971user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
972 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100973 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
974 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100975 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
976 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100977 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
978 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
979
980
981 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100982 userlist L1
983 group G1 users tiger,scott
984 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100985
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100986 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
987 user scott insecure-password elgato
988 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100989
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100990 userlist L2
991 group G1
992 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100993
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100994 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
995 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
996 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100997
998 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200999
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001000
10013.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001002----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001003It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1004haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1005pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1006identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1007or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1008Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1009known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1010the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1011process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1012during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1013tables.
1014
1015peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001016 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001017 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1018
1019peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1020 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1021 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1022 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1023 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1024 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1025 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1026
1027 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1028 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1029
1030 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1031 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1032 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1033 across all peers.
1034
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001035 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1036 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1037 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1038
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001039 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001040 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001041 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1042 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1043 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001044
1045 backend mybackend
1046 mode tcp
1047 balance roundrobin
1048 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1049 stick on src
1050
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001051 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1052 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001053
1054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010554. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001057
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001058Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1059 - defaults <name>
1060 - frontend <name>
1061 - backend <name>
1062 - listen <name>
1063
1064A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1065its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1066section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001067section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
1069A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1070connections.
1071
1072A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1073to forward incoming connections.
1074
1075A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1076parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001078All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1079'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1080case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1081
1082Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1083logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1084proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1085However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1086name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1087
1088Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1089and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001090bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001091protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1092modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1093arbitrary criteria.
1094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010964.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1097--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001099The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1100limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1101they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1102limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001103marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001104option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001105and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1106with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1107specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001108
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001109
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001110 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1111------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1112acl - X X X
1113appsession - - X X
1114backlog X X X -
1115balance X - X X
1116bind - X X -
1117bind-process X X X X
1118block - X X X
1119capture cookie - X X -
1120capture request header - X X -
1121capture response header - X X -
1122clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001123compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001124contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1125cookie X - X X
1126default-server X - X X
1127default_backend X X X -
1128description - X X X
1129disabled X X X X
1130dispatch - - X X
1131enabled X X X X
1132errorfile X X X X
1133errorloc X X X X
1134errorloc302 X X X X
1135-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1136errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001137force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001138fullconn X - X X
1139grace X X X X
1140hash-type X - X X
1141http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001142http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001143http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001144http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001145http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001146id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001147ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001148log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001149maxconn X X X -
1150mode X X X X
1151monitor fail - X X -
1152monitor-net X X X -
1153monitor-uri X X X -
1154option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1155option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1156option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1157option allbackups (*) X - X X
1158option checkcache (*) X - X X
1159option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1160option contstats (*) X X X -
1161option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1162option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1163option forceclose (*) X X X X
1164-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1165option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001166option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001167option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001168option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1169option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1170option httpchk X - X X
1171option httpclose (*) X X X X
1172option httplog X X X X
1173option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001174option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09001175option lb-agent-chk X - X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001176option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001177option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1178option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1179option logasap (*) X X X -
1180option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001181option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001182option nolinger (*) X X X X
1183option originalto X X X X
1184option persist (*) X - X X
1185option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001186option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001187option smtpchk X - X X
1188option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1189option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1190option splice-request (*) X X X X
1191option splice-response (*) X X X X
1192option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1193option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1194-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1195option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1196option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1197option tcpka X X X X
1198option tcplog X X X X
1199option transparent (*) X - X X
1200persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1201rate-limit sessions X X X -
1202redirect - X X X
1203redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1204redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1205reqadd - X X X
1206reqallow - X X X
1207reqdel - X X X
1208reqdeny - X X X
1209reqiallow - X X X
1210reqidel - X X X
1211reqideny - X X X
1212reqipass - X X X
1213reqirep - X X X
1214reqisetbe - X X X
1215reqitarpit - X X X
1216reqpass - X X X
1217reqrep - X X X
1218-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1219reqsetbe - X X X
1220reqtarpit - X X X
1221retries X - X X
1222rspadd - X X X
1223rspdel - X X X
1224rspdeny - X X X
1225rspidel - X X X
1226rspideny - X X X
1227rspirep - X X X
1228rsprep - X X X
1229server - - X X
1230source X - X X
1231srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001232stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001233stats auth X - X X
1234stats enable X - X X
1235stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001236stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001237stats realm X - X X
1238stats refresh X - X X
1239stats scope X - X X
1240stats show-desc X - X X
1241stats show-legends X - X X
1242stats show-node X - X X
1243stats uri X - X X
1244-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1245stick match - - X X
1246stick on - - X X
1247stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001248stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001249stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001250tcp-request connection - X X -
1251tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001252tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001253tcp-response content - - X X
1254tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001255timeout check X - X X
1256timeout client X X X -
1257timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1258timeout connect X - X X
1259timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1260timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1261timeout http-request X X X X
1262timeout queue X - X X
1263timeout server X - X X
1264timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1265timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001266timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001267transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001268unique-id-format X X X -
1269unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001270use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001271use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001272------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1273 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001274
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012764.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1277---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001278
1279This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1280
1281
1282acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1283 Declare or complete an access list.
1284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1285 no | yes | yes | yes
1286 Example:
1287 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1288 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1289 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001291 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001292
1293
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001294appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1295 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001296 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1298 no | no | yes | yes
1299 Arguments :
1300 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1301 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1302
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001303 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001304 checked in each cookie value.
1305
1306 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1307 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1308 milliseconds.
1309
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001310 request-learn
1311 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1312 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1313 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1314 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1315 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1316 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1317
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001318 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1319 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1320 data following this prefix.
1321
1322 Example :
1323 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1324
1325 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1326 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1327
1328 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1329 2 modes are currently supported :
1330 - path-parameters :
1331 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1332 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1333 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1334 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1335 - query-string :
1336 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1337 query string.
1338
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001339 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1340 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1341 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1342 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001343 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1344 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1345 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001346 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1347 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1348
1349 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1350
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001351 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1352 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1353 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001355 Example :
1356 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1357
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001358 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1359 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001360
1361
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001362backlog <conns>
1363 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1365 yes | yes | yes | no
1366 Arguments :
1367 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1368 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001369 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001370
1371 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1372 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1373 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1374 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1375 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1376 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1377 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1378 backlog parameter.
1379
1380 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1381 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1382 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1383
1384 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1385
1386
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001387balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001388balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001389 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1391 yes | no | yes | yes
1392 Arguments :
1393 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1394 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1395 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1396 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1397
1398 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1399 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1400 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1401 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001402 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1403 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1404 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1405 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1406 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1407 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1408 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1409 it, so that you don't worry.
1410
1411 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1412 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1413 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1414 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1415 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1416 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1417 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1418 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001419
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001420 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1421 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1422 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1423 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1424 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1425 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1426 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1427 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1428
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001429 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1430 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1431 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1432 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001433 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001434 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1435 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1436 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1437 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1438 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001439 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1440 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1441 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1442 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1443 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1444 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001445
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001446 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1447 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1448 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1449 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1450 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1451 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1452 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1453 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001454 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001455 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001456 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1457 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1458 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001459
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001460 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1461 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1462 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1463 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1464 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1465 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1466 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1467 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1468 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1469 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1470 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1471 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001472
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001473 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001474 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1475 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1476 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1477 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1478 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1479 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1480 URIs start with a leading "/".
1481
1482 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1483 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1484 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1485 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1486
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001487 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001488 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1489
1490 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001491 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1492 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1493 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1494 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1495 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1496 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1497 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1498 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1499 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1500 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1501 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1502 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1503 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1504 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1505 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1506 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1507 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1508 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1509 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001510
1511 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1512 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1513 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1514 server will receive the request.
1515
1516 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1517 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1518 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1519 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1520 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001521 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1522 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1523 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001524
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001525 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1526 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1527 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1528 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1529 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001530
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001531 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001532 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1533 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1534 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1535
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001536 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1537 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1538 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1539
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001540 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001541 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001542 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1543 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1544 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1545 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1546 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1547 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001548 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001549 used instead.
1550
1551 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1552 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1553 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1554 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1555
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001556 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1557 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1558 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1559
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001560 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001561
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001562 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001563 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1564 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001565
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001566 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001567 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001568
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001569 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1570 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1571 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001572
1573 Examples :
1574 balance roundrobin
1575 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001576 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001577 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1578 balance hdr(host)
1579 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001580
1581 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1582 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1583
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001584 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001585 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1586 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1587 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1588 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1589
1590 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1591 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1592 defaults to 16 kB.
1593
1594 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1595 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1596
1597 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1598 Round Robin.
1599
1600 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1601 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1602 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1603 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1604
1605 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1606
1607 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001608 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001609 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1610 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1611 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001612
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001613 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1614 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615
1616
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001617bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1618bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001619 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1621 no | yes | yes | no
1622 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001623 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1624 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1625 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1626 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001627 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001628 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1629 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1630 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1631 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1632 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1633 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1634 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001635 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1636 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1637 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001638 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1639 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1640 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1641 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001642
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001643 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1644 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001645 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1646 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1647 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001648 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1649 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1650 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1651 the range.
1652
1653 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1654 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1655 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1656 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1657 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1658 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1659 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001660 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001661 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001662
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001663 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1664 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1665 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1666 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1667 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1668 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1669 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1670 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1671
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001672 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1673 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1674 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1675 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001676
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001677 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1678 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1679 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1680 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1681 in a frontend.
1682
1683 Example :
1684 listen http_proxy
1685 bind :80,:443
1686 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001687 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001688
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001689 listen http_https_proxy
1690 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001691 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001692
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001693 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1694 bind ipv6@:80
1695 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1696 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1697
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001698 listen external_bind_app1
1699 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1700
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001701 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001702 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001703
1704
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001705bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001706 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1708 yes | yes | yes | yes
1709 Arguments :
1710 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1711 may be used to override a default value.
1712
1713 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1714 option may be combined with other numbers.
1715
1716 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1717 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1718 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1719 missing from all processes.
1720
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001721 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1722 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1723 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1724 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1725 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001726
1727 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1728 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1729 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1730 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1731 and 'even' instances.
1732
1733 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1734 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1735 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1736 32.
1737
1738 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1739 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1740
1741 Example :
1742 listen app_ip1
1743 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001744 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001745
1746 listen app_ip2
1747 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001748 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001749
1750 listen management
1751 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001752 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001753
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001754 listen management
1755 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1756 bind-process 1-4
1757
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001758 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1759
1760
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001761block { if | unless } <condition>
1762 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1764 no | yes | yes | yes
1765
1766 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1767 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001768 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001769 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001770 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1771 "block" statements per instance.
1772
1773 Example:
1774 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1775 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1776 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1777 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1778
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001779 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780
1781
1782capture cookie <name> len <length>
1783 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1785 no | yes | yes | no
1786 Arguments :
1787 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1788 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1789 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1790 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1791 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1792
1793 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1794 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1795 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1796 right if it exceeds <length>.
1797
1798 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1799 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1800 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1801 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1802
1803 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1804 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1805 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1806
1807 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1808 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1809 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001810 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1811 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1812 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001813
1814 Example:
1815 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1816
1817 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001818 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001819
1820
1821capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001822 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1824 no | yes | yes | no
1825 Arguments :
1826 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001827 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001828 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1829 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1830 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1831
1832 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1833 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1834 it exceeds <length>.
1835
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001836 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001837 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1838 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001839 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1840 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1841 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1842 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001843 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001844 environments to find where the request came from.
1845
1846 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1847 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1848 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1849 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001850
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001851 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1852 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1853 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1854 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1855 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001856
1857 Example:
1858 capture request header Host len 15
1859 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1860 capture request header Referrer len 15
1861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001862 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001863 about logging.
1864
1865
1866capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001867 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1869 no | yes | yes | no
1870 Arguments :
1871 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001872 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001873 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1874 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1875 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1876
1877 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1878 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1879 it exceeds <length>.
1880
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001881 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001882 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1883 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1884 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001885 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1886 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1887 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1888 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001889
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001890 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1891 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1892 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1893 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1894 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001895
1896 Example:
1897 capture response header Content-length len 9
1898 capture response header Location len 15
1899
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001900 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001901 about logging.
1902
1903
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001904clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001905 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1907 yes | yes | yes | no
1908 Arguments :
1909 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1910 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1911 as explained at the top of this document.
1912
1913 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1914 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1915 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1916 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1917 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1918 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1919 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1920 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001921 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001922 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1923 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1924
1925 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1926 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1927 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1928 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1929 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1930 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1931
1932 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1933 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1934
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001935 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1936 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001937
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001938compression algo <algorithm> ...
1939compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001940compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001941 Enable HTTP compression.
1942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1943 yes | yes | yes | yes
1944 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001945 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1946 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1947 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1948
1949 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001950 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001951 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1952 data.
1953
1954 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1955 support for zlib was built in.
1956
1957 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1958 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1959 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1960 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1961 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1962 in.
1963
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001964 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001965 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001966 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1967 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1968 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1969 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1970 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001971
1972 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1973 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1974 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1975 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1976 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001977 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1978 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1979 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1980 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1981 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1982 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001983
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001984 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001985 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
1986 "Accept-Encoding" header
1987 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001988 * HTTP status code is not 200
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001989 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
1990 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
1991 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
1992 "multipart"
1993 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
1994 header
1995 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
1996 and later
1997 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
1998 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001999
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002000 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2001 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002002
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002003 Examples :
2004 compression algo gzip
2005 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002006
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002007contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002008 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2010 yes | no | yes | yes
2011 Arguments :
2012 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2013 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2014 as explained at the top of this document.
2015
2016 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002017 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002018 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002019 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2020 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2021 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2022 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2023
2024 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2025 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2026 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2027 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2028 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2029 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2030
2031 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2032 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2033 instead.
2034
2035 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2036 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2037
2038
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002039cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002040 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2041 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2044 yes | no | yes | yes
2045 Arguments :
2046 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2047 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2048 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2049 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2050 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2051 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2052 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2053 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2054 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2055
2056 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2057 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2058 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2059 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2060 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2061 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2062 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2063 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2064 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2065 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2066 "insert" and "prefix".
2067
2068 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002069 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002070
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002071 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002072 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2073 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2074 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2075 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2076 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2077 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2078 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2079 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2080 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2081 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002082
2083 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2084 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2085 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2086 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2087 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2088 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2089 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2090 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2091 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2092 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002093 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2094 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2095 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002096
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002097 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2098 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2099 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002100 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2101 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2102 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2103 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002104 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2105 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2106 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002107
2108 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2109 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2110 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2111 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2112 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2113 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2114 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2115 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2116 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2117
2118 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2119 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2120 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2121 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2122 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2123 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2124 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2125 persistence cookie in the cache.
2126 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2127
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002128 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2129 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2130 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2131 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2132 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2133 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2134 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2135 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2136 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2137 they logout.
2138
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002139 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2140 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2141 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2142 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2143
2144 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2145 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2146 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2147 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2148 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2149 this attribute.
2150
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002151 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002152 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002153 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2154 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2155 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2156 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2157 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2158 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002159
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002160 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2161 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2162 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2163 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2164 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2165 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2166 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2167 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2168 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2169 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2170 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2171 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2172 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2173 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2174 the site.
2175
2176 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2177 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2178 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2179 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2180 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2181 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2182 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2183 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2184 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2185 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2186 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2187 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2188 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2189 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2190 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2191 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2192
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002193 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2194 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2195 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2196 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002197
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198 Examples :
2199 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2200 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2201 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002202 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002203
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002204 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002205 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002206
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002207
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002208default-server [param*]
2209 Change default options for a server in a backend
2210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2211 yes | no | yes | yes
2212 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002213 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2214 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2215 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2216 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002217
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002218 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002219 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2220
2221 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002222
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002223
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002224default_backend <backend>
2225 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2227 yes | yes | yes | no
2228 Arguments :
2229 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2230
2231 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2232 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2233 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2234 will catch all undetermined requests.
2235
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002236 Example :
2237
2238 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2239 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2240 default_backend dynamic
2241
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002242 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2243
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002244
2245disabled
2246 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2248 yes | yes | yes | yes
2249 Arguments : none
2250
2251 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2252 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2253 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2254 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2255 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2256 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2257 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2258
2259 See also : "enabled"
2260
2261
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002262dispatch <address>:<port>
2263 Set a default server address
2264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2265 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002266 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002267
2268 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2269 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2270 during start-up.
2271
2272 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2273 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2274 possible with normal servers.
2275
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002276 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002277 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2278 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2279 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2280 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2281
2282 See also : "server"
2283
2284
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002285enabled
2286 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2288 yes | yes | yes | yes
2289 Arguments : none
2290
2291 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2292 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2293
2294 See also : "disabled"
2295
2296
2297errorfile <code> <file>
2298 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2300 yes | yes | yes | yes
2301 Arguments :
2302 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002303 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002304
2305 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002306 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002308 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2309 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002310
2311 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2312 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2313 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2314
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002315 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2316
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002317 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2318 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2319 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2320 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2321
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002322 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2323 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2324 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2325 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2326 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2327 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2328
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002329 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2330 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2331 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002332 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2334
2335 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2336
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002337 Example :
2338 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2339 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2340 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2341
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002342
2343errorloc <code> <url>
2344errorloc302 <code> <url>
2345 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2347 yes | yes | yes | yes
2348 Arguments :
2349 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002350 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002351
2352 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2353 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2354 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2355 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2356 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2357
2358 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2359 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2360 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2361
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002362 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2363
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002364 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2365 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2366 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2367 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2368 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2369 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2370 request.
2371
2372 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2373
2374
2375errorloc303 <code> <url>
2376 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2378 yes | yes | yes | yes
2379 Arguments :
2380 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2381 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2382
2383 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2384 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2385 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2386 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2387 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2388
2389 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2390 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2391 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2392
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002393 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2394
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002395 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2396 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2397 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2398 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002399 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002400
2401 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2402
2403
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002404force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2405 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2406 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2407 no | yes | yes | yes
2408
2409 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2410 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2411 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2412 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2413 marked down for maintenance operations.
2414
2415 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2416 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2417 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2418 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2419 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2420 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2421 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2422 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2423 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2424
2425 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2426 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2427 is used.
2428
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002429 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002430 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002431
2432
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002433fullconn <conns>
2434 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2436 yes | no | yes | yes
2437 Arguments :
2438 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2439 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2440
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002441 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002442 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002443 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002444 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2445 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2446 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2447 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2448 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002449 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002450
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002451 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2452 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2453 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2454
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002455 Example :
2456 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2457 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2458 # connections.
2459 backend dynamic
2460 fullconn 10000
2461 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2462 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2463
2464 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2465
2466
2467grace <time>
2468 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002470 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002471 Arguments :
2472 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2473 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2474 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2475
2476 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2477 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002478 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002479 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2480
2481 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2482 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2483 simplify it.
2484
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002485
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002486hash-type <method>
2487 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2489 yes | no | yes | yes
2490 Arguments :
2491 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2492 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2493 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2494 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2495 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2496 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2497 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2498 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2499 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2500
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002501 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2502 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2503 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2504 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2505 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2506 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2507 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2508 this value.
2509
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002510 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2511 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2512 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2513 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2514 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2515 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2516 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2517 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2518 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2519 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2520 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2521 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2522 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2523
2524 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2525
2526 See also : "balance", "server"
2527
2528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002529http-check disable-on-404
2530 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002532 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002533 Arguments : none
2534
2535 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2536 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2537 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2538 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2539 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2540 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2541 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2542 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002543 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2544 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2545 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2546
2547 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2548
2549
2550http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002551 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002553 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002554 Arguments :
2555 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2556 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002557 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002558 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2559 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2560 details on the supported keywords.
2561
2562 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2563 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2564 with the usual backslash ('\').
2565
2566 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2567 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2568 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2569 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2570 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2571
2572 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002573 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002574 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2575 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2576 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2577
2578 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002579 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002580 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2581 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2582 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2583 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2584
2585 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002586 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002587 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2588 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2589 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2590 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2591 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2592 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2593 trace).
2594
2595 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002596 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002597 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2598 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2599 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2600 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2601 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2602 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2603
2604 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2605 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2606 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2607 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2608 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2609 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2610 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2611 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2612
2613 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2614 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2615
2616 Examples :
2617 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002618 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002619
2620 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002621 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002622
2623 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002624 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002625
2626 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002627 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002628
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002629 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002630
2631
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002632http-check send-state
2633 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2635 yes | no | yes | yes
2636 Arguments : none
2637
2638 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2639 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2640 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2641 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2642 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2643
2644 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2645 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2646 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2647 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2648 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2649 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2650 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2651 checked in multiple backends.
2652
2653 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2654 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2655
2656 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2657 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2658 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2659 one fails.
2660
2661 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2662 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2663 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2664
2665 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2666 server's queue.
2667
2668 Example of a header received by the application server :
2669 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2670 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2671
2672 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2673
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002674http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002675 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002676 set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> | set-tos <tos> |
2677 set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002678 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002679 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2680
2681 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2682 no | yes | yes | yes
2683
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002684 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2685 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2686 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2687 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2688 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002689
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002690 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2691 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2692 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2693
2694 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2695 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2696 are evaluated.
2697
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002698 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2699 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2700 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2701 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2702 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2703 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2704 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2705 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2706 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2707 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2708 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2709
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002710 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2711 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2712 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2713 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2714 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2715
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002716 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2717 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2718 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
2719 "http-request" rules. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
2720
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002721 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2722 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2723 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2724 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2725 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2726 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2727 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2728 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2729
2730 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2731 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2732 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2733 external users.
2734
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002735 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2736 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2737 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2738 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2739 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2740 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2741 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2742 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2743
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002744 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2745 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2746 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2747 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2748 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2749 another equipment.
2750
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002751 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2752 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2753 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2754 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2755 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2756 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2757 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2758 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2759
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002760 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2761 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2762 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2763 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2764 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2765 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2766 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2767 admin privileges.
2768
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002769 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2770
2771 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2772 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2773 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2774 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002775
2776 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002777 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2778 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2779 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002780
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002781 http-request allow if nagios
2782 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2783 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2784 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002785
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002786 Example:
2787 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002788 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002789
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002790 Example:
2791 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2792 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2793 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2794 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2795 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2796 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2797 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2798 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2799 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2800
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002801 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2802 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002803
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002804http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002805 set-header <name> <fmt> | set-log-level <level> |
2806 set-mark <mark> } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002807 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2808
2809 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2810 no | yes | yes | yes
2811
2812 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2813 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2814 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2815 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2816 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2817 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2818
2819 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2820 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2821 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2822 current section.
2823
2824 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2825 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2826 rules are evaluated.
2827
2828 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2829 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2830 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
2831 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
2832 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
2833 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
2834 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
2835
2836 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2837 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2838 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2839 external users.
2840
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002841 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2842 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2843 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2844 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2845 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2846 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2847 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2848 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2849
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002850 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2851 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2852 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2853 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2854 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2855 another equipment.
2856
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002857 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2858 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2859 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2860 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2861 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2862 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2863 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2864 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2865
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002866 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2867 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2868 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2869 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2870 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2871 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2872 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2873 admin privileges.
2874
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002875 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
2876
2877 It is important to know that http-reqsponse rules are processed very early in
2878 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
2879 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
2880 rules.
2881
2882 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
2883 ACL usage.
2884
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002885http-send-name-header [<header>]
2886 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2887
2888 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2889 yes | no | yes | yes
2890
2891 Arguments :
2892
2893 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2894
2895 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2896 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2897 is added with the header string proved.
2898
2899 See also : "server"
2900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002901id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002902 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2904 no | yes | yes | yes
2905 Arguments : none
2906
2907 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2908 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2909 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002910
2911
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002912ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2913 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2914 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2915 no | yes | yes | yes
2916
2917 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2918 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2919 and running).
2920
2921 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2922 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2923 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2924 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2925 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2926
2927 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2928 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2929
2930 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2931 "unless" condition is met.
2932
2933 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2934
2935
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002936log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002937log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002938no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002939 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2941 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002942
2943 Prefix :
2944 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2945 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2946 prefix does not allow arguments.
2947
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002948 Arguments :
2949 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2950 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2951 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2952 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2953 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2954 parameter.
2955
2956 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2957 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2958
2959 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2960 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2961 standard syslog port).
2962
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002963 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2964 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2965 standard syslog port).
2966
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002967 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2968 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2969 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2970 appropriately writeable).
2971
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002972 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
2973 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
2974 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
2975 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
2976
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002977 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2978
2979 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2980 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2981 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2982
2983 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2984 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2985 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002986 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2987 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2988 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2989 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2990 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002991
2992 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2993
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002994 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2995 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2996 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002997
2998 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2999 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3000 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3001 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3002
3003 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3004 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003005
3006 Example :
3007 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003008 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3009 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003010 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3011
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003012
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003013log-format <string>
3014 Allows you to custom a log line.
3015
3016 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3017
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003018
3019maxconn <conns>
3020 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3022 yes | yes | yes | no
3023 Arguments :
3024 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3025 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3026 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3027 closes.
3028
3029 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3030 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3031 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3032 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3033 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3034 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3035 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3036 properly tuned.
3037
3038 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3039 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3040 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3041
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003042 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3043
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003044 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3045
3046
3047mode { tcp|http|health }
3048 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3050 yes | yes | yes | yes
3051 Arguments :
3052 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3053 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3054 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3055 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3056
3057 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3058 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3059 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3060 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3061 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3062
3063 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003064 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3065 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3066 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3067 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3068 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3069 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3070 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003071
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003072 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3073 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3074 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003075
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003076 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003077 defaults http_instances
3078 mode http
3079
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003080 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003081
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003083monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003084 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3086 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003087 Arguments :
3088 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3089 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003090 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003091 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3092 backend and its backup.
3093
3094 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3095 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3096 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3097 servers in a list of backends.
3098
3099 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3100 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3101 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3102 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3103 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3104 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3105 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003106 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3107 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003108
3109 Example:
3110 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003111 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003112 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3113 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3114 monitor-uri /site_alive
3115 monitor fail if site_dead
3116
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003117 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003118
3119
3120monitor-net <source>
3121 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3123 yes | yes | yes | no
3124 Arguments :
3125 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3126 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3127 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3128 followed by a mask.
3129
3130 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3131 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003132 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003133 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3134
3135 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3136 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3137 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3138 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003139 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3140 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3141 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003142
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003143 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3144 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3145 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3146 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3147 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3148 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003149
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003150 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3151 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003152
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003153 Example :
3154 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3155 frontend www
3156 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3157
3158 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3159
3160
3161monitor-uri <uri>
3162 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3164 yes | yes | yes | no
3165 Arguments :
3166 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3167 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3168
3169 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3170 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3171 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3172 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3173 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3174 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3175 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3176 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3177
3178 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3179 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3180 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3181 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3182 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3183 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3184
3185 Example :
3186 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3187 frontend www
3188 mode http
3189 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3190
3191 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3192
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003193
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003194option abortonclose
3195no option abortonclose
3196 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3198 yes | no | yes | yes
3199 Arguments : none
3200
3201 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3202 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3203 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3204 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003205 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003206 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3207 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3208 encountered while delivering the response.
3209
3210 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3211 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3212 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3213 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3214 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3215 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003216 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003217 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003218 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003219 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3220 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3221 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3222
3223 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3224 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3225 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3226 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3227 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3228 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3229 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3230 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003231 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003232
3233 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3234 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3235
3236 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3237
3238
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003239option accept-invalid-http-request
3240no option accept-invalid-http-request
3241 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3243 yes | yes | yes | no
3244 Arguments : none
3245
3246 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3247 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3248 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3249 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3250 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3251 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3252 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3253 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003254 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3255 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3256 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3257 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3258 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3259 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003260
3261 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3262 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3263 been confirmed.
3264
3265 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3266 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003267 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3268 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003269 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3270
3271 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3272 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3273
3274 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3275 stats socket.
3276
3277
3278option accept-invalid-http-response
3279no option accept-invalid-http-response
3280 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3282 yes | no | yes | yes
3283 Arguments : none
3284
3285 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3286 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3287 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3288 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3289 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3290 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3291 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3292 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3293 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3294
3295 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3296 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3297 been confirmed.
3298
3299 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3300 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3301 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3302 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3303
3304 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3305 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3306
3307 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3308 stats socket.
3309
3310
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003311option allbackups
3312no option allbackups
3313 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3315 yes | no | yes | yes
3316 Arguments : none
3317
3318 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3319 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3320 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3321 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3322 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3323 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3324 order between the backup servers anymore.
3325
3326 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3327 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3328
3329 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3330 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3331
3332
3333option checkcache
3334no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003335 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3337 yes | no | yes | yes
3338 Arguments : none
3339
3340 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3341 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003342 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003343 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3344 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003345 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003346
3347 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003348 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003349 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003350 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3351 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003352 to the client are :
3353 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003354 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003355 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003356 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3357 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3358 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3359 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3360 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3361 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3362 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3363 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3364 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3365 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3366 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3367
3368 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003369 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003370 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003371 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003372 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3373
3374 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3375 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003376 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003377 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3378
3379 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3380 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3381
3382
3383option clitcpka
3384no option clitcpka
3385 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3387 yes | yes | yes | no
3388 Arguments : none
3389
3390 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3391 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3392 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3393 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3394
3395 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3396 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3397 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3398 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3399
3400 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3401 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3402 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3403 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3404 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3405
3406 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3407
3408 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3409 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3410 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3411
3412 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3413 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3414
3415 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3416
3417
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003418option contstats
3419 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3421 yes | yes | yes | no
3422 Arguments : none
3423
3424 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3425 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3426 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3427 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3428 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3429 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3430 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3431
3432
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003433option dontlog-normal
3434no option dontlog-normal
3435 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3437 yes | yes | yes | no
3438 Arguments : none
3439
3440 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3441 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3442 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3443 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3444 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3445 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3446 logged.
3447
3448 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3449 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3450 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003452 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003453 logging.
3454
3455
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003456option dontlognull
3457no option dontlognull
3458 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3460 yes | yes | yes | no
3461 Arguments : none
3462
3463 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3464 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3465 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3466 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3467 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3468 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3469 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3470
3471 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3472 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3473 would not be logged.
3474
3475 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3476 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003478 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003479
3480
3481option forceclose
3482no option forceclose
3483 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003485 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003486 Arguments : none
3487
3488 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3489 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3490 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3491 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3492 global session times in the logs.
3493
3494 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003495 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003496 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3497 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3498 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3499 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003500
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003501 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3502 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3503 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3504
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003505 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3506 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3507
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003508 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003509
3510
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003511option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003512 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3514 yes | yes | yes | yes
3515 Arguments :
3516 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3517 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003518 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003519 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003520
3521 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3522 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3523 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3524 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3525 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3526 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3527 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003528 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3529 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3530 possible that the client has already brought one.
3531
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003532 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003533 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003534 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3535 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003536 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3537 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003538
3539 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3540 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3541 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3542 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3543 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3544 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3545 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3546
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003547 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3548 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3549 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3550 are under the control of the end-user.
3551
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003552 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003553 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3554 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003555 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3556 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3557 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003558
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003559 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3560 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3561 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3562 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3563 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003564
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003565 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003566 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3567 frontend www
3568 mode http
3569 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3570
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003571 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3572 backend www
3573 mode http
3574 option forwardfor header X-Client
3575
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003576 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3577 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003578
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003579
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003580option http-no-delay
3581no option http-no-delay
3582 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3584 yes | yes | yes | yes
3585 Arguments : none
3586
3587 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3588 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3589 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3590 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3591 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3592 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3593 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3594 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3595 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3596 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3597 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3598 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3599 affected.
3600
3601 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3602 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3603 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3604 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3605 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3606 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3607 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3608 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3609 latency environments.
3610
3611
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003612option http-pretend-keepalive
3613no option http-pretend-keepalive
3614 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3616 yes | yes | yes | yes
3617 Arguments : none
3618
3619 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3620 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3621 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3622 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3623 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3624 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3625 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3626 consider the response complete.
3627
3628 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3629 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3630 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3631 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3632 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3633 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3634
3635 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3636 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3637 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3638 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3639 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3640 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3641 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3642
3643 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3644 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003645 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003646 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3647 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003648
3649 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3650 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3651
3652 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3653
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003654
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003655option http-server-close
3656no option http-server-close
3657 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3659 yes | yes | yes | yes
3660 Arguments : none
3661
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003662 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3663 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3664 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3665 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3666 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3667 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3668 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3669 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3670 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3671 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3672 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3673 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003674
3675 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3676 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3677 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3678 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003679 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3680 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003681
3682 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3683 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003684 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3685 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3686 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003687
3688 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3689 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3690
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003691 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3692 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003693
3694
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003695option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003696no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003697 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3699 yes | yes | yes | no
3700 Arguments : none
3701
3702 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3703 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3704 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3705 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3706 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3707 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3708 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3709
3710 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3711 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3712 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3713 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3714 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3715 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3716 request along its whole life.
3717
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003718 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3719 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3720 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3721 front of an existing proxy.
3722
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003723 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3724
3725 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3726 http-server-close".
3727
3728
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003729option httpchk
3730option httpchk <uri>
3731option httpchk <method> <uri>
3732option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3733 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3735 yes | no | yes | yes
3736 Arguments :
3737 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3738 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3739 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3740 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3741 ones.
3742
3743 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3744 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3745 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3746
3747 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3748 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3749 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3750 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3751 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3752
3753 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3754 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3755 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3756 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3757 the lack of any response.
3758
3759 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3760
3761 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3762 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3763 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3764
3765 Examples :
3766 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3767 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3768 backend https_relay
3769 mode tcp
3770 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3771 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3772
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09003773 See also : "option lb-agent-chk", "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk",
3774 "option mysql-check", "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and
3775 the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003776
3777
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003778option httpclose
3779no option httpclose
3780 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3782 yes | yes | yes | yes
3783 Arguments : none
3784
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003785 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3786 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3787 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3788 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3789 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3790 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3791 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003792
3793 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003794 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003795 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3796 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3797 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3798 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3799 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003800
3801 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3802 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3803 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003804 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3805 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003806
3807 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3808 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3809
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003810 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3811 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003812
3813
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003814option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003815 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3817 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003818 Arguments :
3819 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3820 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3821 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3822 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3823 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003824
3825 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3826 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3827 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3828 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3829 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3830 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3831 ports.
3832
3833 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3834
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003835 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3836 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3837 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3838 by default.
3839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003840 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003841
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003842
3843option http_proxy
3844no option http_proxy
3845 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3847 yes | yes | yes | yes
3848 Arguments : none
3849
3850 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3851 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3852 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3853 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3854 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3855
3856 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3857 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3858 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3859 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003860 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003861 be analyzed.
3862
3863 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3864 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3865
3866 Example :
3867 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3868 backend direct_forward
3869 option httpclose
3870 option http_proxy
3871
3872 See also : "option httpclose"
3873
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003874
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003875option independent-streams
3876no option independent-streams
3877 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3879 yes | yes | yes | yes
3880 Arguments : none
3881
3882 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3883 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3884 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3885 receive data or not.
3886
3887 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3888 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3889 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3890 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3891 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3892 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3893 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3894 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3895 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3896 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3897 socket buffers.
3898
3899 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3900 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3901 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3902 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3903 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3904
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003905 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3906 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3907 deprecated.
3908
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003909 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003910
3911
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09003912option lb-agent-chk
3913 Use a TCP connection to obtain a metric of server health
3914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3915 yes | no | yes | yes
3916 Arguments : none
3917
3918 This alters health checking behaviour by connecting making a TCP
3919 connection and reading an ASCII string. The string should have one of
3920 the following forms:
3921
3922 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
3923 e.g. "75%"
3924
3925 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
3926 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
3927
3928 * The string "drain".
3929
3930 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
3931 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
3932 persistence.
3933
3934 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
3935
3936 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
3937
3938 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
3939
3940 This currently has the same behaviour as down (iii).
3941
3942 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
3943
3944 This currently has the same behaviour as down (iii).
3945
3946 The use of an alternate check-port, used to obtain agent heath check
3947 information described above as opposed to the port of the service, may be
3948 useful in conjunction with this option.
3949
3950
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003951option ldap-check
3952 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3954 yes | no | yes | yes
3955 Arguments : none
3956
3957 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3958 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3959 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3960 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3961
3962 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3963 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3964
3965 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3966 configure it.
3967
3968 Example :
3969 option ldap-check
3970
3971 See also : "option httpchk"
3972
3973
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003974option log-health-checks
3975no option log-health-checks
3976 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3978 yes | no | yes | yes
3979 Arguments : none
3980
3981 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3982 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3983 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3984 of additional information is limited.
3985
3986 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3987 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3988
3989 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3990
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003991
3992option log-separate-errors
3993no option log-separate-errors
3994 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3996 yes | yes | yes | no
3997 Arguments : none
3998
3999 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4000 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4001 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4002 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4003 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4004 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4005 provides very important information.
4006
4007 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4008 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4009 error logs.
4010
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004011 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004012 logging.
4013
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004014
4015option logasap
4016no option logasap
4017 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4019 yes | yes | yes | no
4020 Arguments : none
4021
4022 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4023 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4024 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4025 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4026 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4027 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4028 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004029 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004030 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4031 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4032
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004033 Examples :
4034 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4035 mode http
4036 option httplog
4037 option logasap
4038 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4039
4040 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4041 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4042 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4043 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004045 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004046 logging.
4047
4048
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004049option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4050 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4052 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004053 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004054 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4055 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004056
4057 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4058 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4059 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4060 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4061 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4062 in the MySQL table, like this :
4063
4064 USE mysql;
4065 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4066 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4067
4068 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4069 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4070 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4071 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4072 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4073 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4074 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4075 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4076 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4077
4078 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4079 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004080
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004081 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004082
4083 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4084 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4085 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4086 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4087 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4088 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4089
4090 See also: "option httpchk"
4091
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01004092option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4093 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4095 yes | no | yes | yes
4096 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004097 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4098 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01004099
4100 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4101 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4102 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4103 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4104
4105 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004106
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004107option nolinger
4108no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004109 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004110 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4111 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004112 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004113
4114 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4115 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4116 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4117 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4118 connections.
4119
4120 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4121 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4122 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4123 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4124 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4125 this too.
4126
4127 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4128 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4129 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4130
4131 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4132 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4133 for servers.
4134
4135 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4136 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4137
4138
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004139option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4140 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4142 yes | yes | yes | yes
4143 Arguments :
4144 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4145 matching <network>
4146 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4147 header name.
4148
4149 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4150 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4151 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4152 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4153 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4154 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4155 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4156 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4157 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4158 possible that the client has already brought one.
4159
4160 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4161 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4162 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4163 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4164 header and requires different one.
4165
4166 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4167 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4168 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4169 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4170 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4171 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4172 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4173
4174 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4175 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4176 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4177 both are defined.
4178
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004179 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
4180 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
4181 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
4182 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
4183 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004184
4185 Examples :
4186 # Original Destination address
4187 frontend www
4188 mode http
4189 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4190
4191 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4192 backend www
4193 mode http
4194 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4195
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004196 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4197 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004198
4199
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004200option persist
4201no option persist
4202 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4203 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4204 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004205 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004206
4207 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4208 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4209 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4210 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4211 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4212 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4213 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4214 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4215 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4216 redirected to another valid server.
4217
4218 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4219 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4220
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004221 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004222
4223
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004224option redispatch
4225no option redispatch
4226 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4227 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4228 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004229 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004230
4231 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4232 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4233 be able to access the service anymore.
4234
4235 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4236 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4237
4238 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4239 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4240 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004242 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4243 "redisp" keywords.
4244
4245 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4246 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4247
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004248 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004249
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004250
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004251option redis-check
4252 Use redis health checks for server testing
4253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4254 yes | no | yes | yes
4255 Arguments : none
4256
4257 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4258 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4259 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4260 find the "+PONG" response message.
4261
4262 Example :
4263 option redis-check
4264
4265 See also : "option httpchk"
4266
4267
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004268option smtpchk
4269option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4270 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4272 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004273 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004274 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4275 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4276 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4277
4278 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4279 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4280 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4281
4282 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4283 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4284 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4285 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4286 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4287 dead server.
4288
4289 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4290 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4291 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4292 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4293
4294 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4295 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4296 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4297 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4298 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4299
4300 Example :
4301 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4302
4303 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4304
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004305
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004306option socket-stats
4307no option socket-stats
4308
4309 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4311 yes | yes | yes | no
4312
4313 Arguments : none
4314
4315
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004316option splice-auto
4317no option splice-auto
4318 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4320 yes | yes | yes | yes
4321 Arguments : none
4322
4323 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4324 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4325 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4326 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004327 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004328 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4329 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4330 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4331 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4332
4333 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4334 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4335 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4336 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4337 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4338 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4339 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4340 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4341 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4342 keyword.
4343
4344 Example :
4345 option splice-auto
4346
4347 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4348 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4349
4350 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4351 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4352
4353
4354option splice-request
4355no option splice-request
4356 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4358 yes | yes | yes | yes
4359 Arguments : none
4360
4361 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004362 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004363 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4364 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4365 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4366 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4367
4368 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4369
4370 Example :
4371 option splice-request
4372
4373 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4374 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4375
4376 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4377 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4378
4379
4380option splice-response
4381no option splice-response
4382 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4384 yes | yes | yes | yes
4385 Arguments : none
4386
4387 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004388 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004389 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4390 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4391 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4392 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4393
4394 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4395
4396 Example :
4397 option splice-response
4398
4399 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4400 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4401
4402 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4403 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4404
4405
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004406option srvtcpka
4407no option srvtcpka
4408 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4410 yes | no | yes | yes
4411 Arguments : none
4412
4413 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4414 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4415 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4416 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4417
4418 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4419 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4420 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4421 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4422
4423 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4424 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4425 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4426 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4427 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4428
4429 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4430
4431 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4432 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4433 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4434
4435 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4436 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4437
4438 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4439
4440
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004441option ssl-hello-chk
4442 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4444 yes | no | yes | yes
4445 Arguments : none
4446
4447 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4448 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4449 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4450 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4451 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4452 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4453 hello message.
4454
4455 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4456 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4457 messages, which is appreciable.
4458
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004459 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4460 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4461 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004462
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004463 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4464
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004465
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004466option tcp-smart-accept
4467no option tcp-smart-accept
4468 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4470 yes | yes | yes | no
4471 Arguments : none
4472
4473 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4474 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4475 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4476 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4477 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4478 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4479
4480 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4481 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4482 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4483 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4484
4485 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4486 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4487 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4488 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4489
4490 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4491 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4492 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4493
4494 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4495 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4496 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4497
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004498 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4499
4500
4501option tcp-smart-connect
4502no option tcp-smart-connect
4503 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4505 yes | no | yes | yes
4506 Arguments : none
4507
4508 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4509 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4510 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4511 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4512 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4513
4514 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4515 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4516 complex.
4517
4518 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4519 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4520 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4521
4522 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4523 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4524
4525 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4526
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004527
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004528option tcpka
4529 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4531 yes | yes | yes | yes
4532 Arguments : none
4533
4534 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4535 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4536 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4537 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4538
4539 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4540 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4541 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4542 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4543
4544 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4545 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4546 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4547 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4548 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4549
4550 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4551
4552 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4553 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4554 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4555 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4556 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4557 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4558 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4559 backends.
4560
4561 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4562
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004563
4564option tcplog
4565 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4567 yes | yes | yes | yes
4568 Arguments : none
4569
4570 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4571 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4572 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4573 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4574 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4575 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4576 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4577 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4578
4579 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4580
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004581 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004582
4583
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004584option transparent
4585no option transparent
4586 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004588 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004589 Arguments : none
4590
4591 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4592 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4593 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4594 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4595 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4596 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4597 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4598 appropriate server.
4599
4600 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4601 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4602
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004603 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004604 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004605
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004606
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004607persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004608persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004609 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4611 yes | no | yes | yes
4612 Arguments :
4613 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004614 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4615 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004616
4617 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4618 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4619 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4620 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4621 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4622 forwarded to this server.
4623
4624 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4625 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4626 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004627 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004628 a single "listen" section.
4629
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004630 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4631 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4632 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4633
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004634 Example :
4635 listen tse-farm
4636 bind :3389
4637 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4638 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4639 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4640 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4641 persist rdp-cookie
4642 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004643 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004644 balance rdp-cookie
4645 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4646 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4647
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004648 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4649 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004650
4651
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004652rate-limit sessions <rate>
4653 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4655 yes | yes | yes | no
4656 Arguments :
4657 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4658 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4659
4660 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4661 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4662 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4663 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4664 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4665 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4666
4667 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4668 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4669 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4670 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4671
4672 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4673 listen smtp
4674 mode tcp
4675 bind :25
4676 rate-limit sessions 10
4677 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4678
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004679 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4680 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4681 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004682
4683 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4684
4685
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004686redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4687redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4688redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004689 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4691 no | yes | yes | yes
4692
4693 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004694 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004695
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004696 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004697 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4698 the HTTP "Location" header.
4699
4700 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4701 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4702 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4703 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4704 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4705 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4706
4707 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4708 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4709 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4710 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4711 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4712 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4713 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4714 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4715 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004716
4717 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01004718 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
4719 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
4720 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
4721 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
4722 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
4723 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
4724 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
4725 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004726
4727 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4728 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4729
4730 - "drop-query"
4731 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4732 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4733 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4734 with a location-type redirect.
4735
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004736 - "append-slash"
4737 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4738 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4739 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4740 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4741
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004742 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4743 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4744 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4745 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4746 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4747 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4748 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4749
4750 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4751 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4752 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4753 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4754 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4755 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4756 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004757
4758 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4759 acl clear dst_port 80
4760 acl secure dst_port 8080
4761 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004762 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004763 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004764 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4765
4766 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004767 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4768 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4769 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004770 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004771
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004772 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4773 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4774 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4775
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004776 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004777 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004778
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004779 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004780
4781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004782redisp (deprecated)
4783redispatch (deprecated)
4784 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4785 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4786 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004787 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004788
4789 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4790 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4791 be able to access the service anymore.
4792
4793 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4794 redistribute them to a working server.
4795
4796 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4797 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4798 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004799
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004800 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4801 "option redispatch" instead.
4802
4803 See also : "option redispatch"
4804
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004805
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004806reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004807 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4809 no | yes | yes | yes
4810 Arguments :
4811 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4812 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004813 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004814
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004815 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4816 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4817
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004818 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4819 the last header of an HTTP request.
4820
4821 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4822 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4823 responses.
4824
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004825 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4826 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4827 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4828
4829 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4830 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004831
4832
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004833reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4834reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004835 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4837 no | yes | yes | yes
4838 Arguments :
4839 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4840 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4841 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4842 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4843 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4844 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4845 ignores case.
4846
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004847 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4848 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4849
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004850 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4851 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4852 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4853 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004854 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004855
4856 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4857 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4858
4859 Example :
4860 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4861 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4862 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4863
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004864 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4865 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004866
4867
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004868reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4869reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004870 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4872 no | yes | yes | yes
4873 Arguments :
4874 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4875 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4876 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4877 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4878 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4879 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4880
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004881 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4882 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4883
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004884 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4885 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4886 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4887 next servers.
4888
4889 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4890 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4891 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4892
4893 Example :
4894 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4895 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4896 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4897
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004898 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4899 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004900
4901
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004902reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4903reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004904 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4906 no | yes | yes | yes
4907 Arguments :
4908 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4909 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4910 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4911 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4912 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4913 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4914 case.
4915
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004916 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4917 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4918
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004919 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4920 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4921 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4922 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004923 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004924
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004925 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004926 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004927 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004928
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004929 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4930 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4931
4932 Example :
4933 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4934 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4935 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4936
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004937 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4938 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004939
4940
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004941reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4942reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004943 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4945 no | yes | yes | yes
4946 Arguments :
4947 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4948 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4949 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4950 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4951 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4952 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4953 case.
4954
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004955 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4956 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4957
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004958 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4959 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4960 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4961 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4962
4963 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4964 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4965
4966 Example :
4967 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4968 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4969 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4970 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4971
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004972 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4973 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004974
4975
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004976reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4977reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004978 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4980 no | yes | yes | yes
4981 Arguments :
4982 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4983 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4984 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4985 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4986 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4987 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4988
4989 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4990 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4991 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4992 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004993 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004994
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004995 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4996 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4997
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004998 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4999 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5000 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5001
5002 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5003 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5004 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5005 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5006 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5007
5008 Example :
5009 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005010 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005011 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5012 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5013
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005014 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5015 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005016
5017
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005018reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5019reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005020 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5022 no | yes | yes | yes
5023 Arguments :
5024 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5025 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5026 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5027 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5028 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5029 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5030 ignores case.
5031
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005032 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5033 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5034
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005035 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5036 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005037 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5038 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5039 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005040 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5041 not set.
5042
5043 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5044 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5045 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5046 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5047 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5048
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005049 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005050 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5051 # block all others.
5052 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5053 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5054
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005055 # block bad guys
5056 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5057 reqitarpit . if badguys
5058
5059 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5060 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005061
5062
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005063retries <value>
5064 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5065 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5066 yes | no | yes | yes
5067 Arguments :
5068 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5069 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5070 default value is 3.
5071
5072 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5073 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5074 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5075
5076 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5077 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5078
5079 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5080 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5081
5082 See also : "option redispatch"
5083
5084
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005085rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005086 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5088 no | yes | yes | yes
5089 Arguments :
5090 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5091 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005092 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005093
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005094 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5095 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5096
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005097 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5098 the last header of an HTTP response.
5099
5100 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5101 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5102 responses.
5103
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005104 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5105 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005106
5107
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005108rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5109rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005110 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5112 no | yes | yes | yes
5113 Arguments :
5114 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5115 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5116 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5117 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5118 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5119 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5120 ignores case.
5121
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005122 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5123 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5124
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005125 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5126 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005127 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005128 client.
5129
5130 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5131 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5132 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5133
5134 Example :
5135 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005136 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005137
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005138 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5139 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005140
5141
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005142rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5143rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005144 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5146 no | yes | yes | yes
5147 Arguments :
5148 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5149 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5150 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5151 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5152 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5153 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5154 ignores case.
5155
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005156 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5157 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5158
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005159 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5160 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5161 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5162 case-sensitive.
5163
5164 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005165 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5166 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5167 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005168
5169 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5170 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5171
5172 Example :
5173 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5174 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5175
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005176 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5177 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005178
5179
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005180rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5181rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005182 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5184 no | yes | yes | yes
5185 Arguments :
5186 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5187 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5188 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5189 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5190 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5191 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5192 ignores case.
5193
5194 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5195 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5196 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5197 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005198 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005199
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005200 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5201 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5202
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005203 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5204 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5205 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5206
5207 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5208 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5209 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5210 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5211 are not case-sensitive.
5212
5213 Example :
5214 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5215 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5216
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005217 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5218 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005219
5220
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005221server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005222 Declare a server in a backend
5223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5224 no | no | yes | yes
5225 Arguments :
5226 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005227 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005228 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005229
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005230 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5231 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5232 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5233 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005234 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5235 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5236 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5237 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5238 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005239 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5240 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5241 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5242 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5243 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5244 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5245 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005246 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5247 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5248 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5249 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005250
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005251 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005252 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5253 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5254 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5255 adding this value to the client's port.
5256
5257 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5258 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005259 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005260
5261 Examples :
5262 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5263 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005264 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005265 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5266 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5267 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005268
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005269 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5270 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005271
5272
5273source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005274source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005275source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005276 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5278 yes | no | yes | yes
5279 Arguments :
5280 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5281 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005282
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005283 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005284 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5285 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5286 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5287 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5288 supported prefixes are :
5289 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5290 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5291 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005292 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5293 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5294 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5295 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005296
5297 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5298 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005299 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5300 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5301 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005302
5303 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5304 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5305 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5306 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5307 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5308 <addr>.
5309
5310 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5311 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5312 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5313 port.
5314
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005315 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5316 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5317 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5318 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005319 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005320 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5321 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5322 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5323 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5324 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5325 HTTP header.
5326
5327 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5328 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005329 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005330 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5331 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5332 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5333 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5334 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5335 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5336 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5337
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005338 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5339 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5340 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5341 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5342 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5343 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5344
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005345 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5346 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5347 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5348 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5349
5350 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5351 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5352 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5353 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5354 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5355 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5356
5357 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5358 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5359 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5360 there are two methods :
5361
5362 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5363 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5364 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5365 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5366 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5367 of the client ranges may be used.
5368
5369 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5370 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5371 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5372 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5373 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5374 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5375 same session.
5376
5377 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5378 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5379 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5380 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5381 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5382 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5383
5384 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5385 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5386 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005387 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005388
5389 Examples :
5390 backend private
5391 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5392 source 192.168.1.200
5393
5394 backend transparent_ssl1
5395 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5396 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5397
5398 backend transparent_ssl2
5399 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5400 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5401 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5402
5403 backend transparent_ssl3
5404 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5405 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5406 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5407
5408 backend transparent_smtp
5409 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5410 # with Tproxy version 4.
5411 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5412
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005413 backend transparent_http
5414 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5415 # proxy.
5416 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005418 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005419 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5420
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005421
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005422srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5423 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5425 yes | no | yes | yes
5426 Arguments :
5427 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5428 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5429 as explained at the top of this document.
5430
5431 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5432 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5433 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5434 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5435 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5436 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5437 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5438
5439 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5440 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5441 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5442 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5443 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005444 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005445 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005446 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005447
5448 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5449 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5450 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5451 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5452 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5453 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5454
5455 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5456 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5457
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005458 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5459 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005460
5461
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005462stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5463 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5465 no | no | yes | yes
5466
5467 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5468 matched.
5469
5470 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5471 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5472
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005473 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5474 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5475 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5476
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005477 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5478 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5479 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5480 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005481
5482 Example :
5483 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5484 backend stats_localhost
5485 stats enable
5486 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5487
5488 Example :
5489 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5490 backend stats_auth
5491 stats enable
5492 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5493 stats admin if TRUE
5494
5495 Example :
5496 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5497 userlist stats-auth
5498 group admin users admin
5499 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5500 group readonly users haproxy
5501 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5502
5503 backend stats_auth
5504 stats enable
5505 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5506 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5507 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5508 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5509
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005510 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5511 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5512 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005513
5514
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005515stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5516 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5518 yes | no | yes | yes
5519 Arguments :
5520 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5521
5522 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5523
5524 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5525 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5526 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5527 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5528 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5529 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5530
5531 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5532 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5533 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005534 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005535
5536 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5537 report using "stats scope".
5538
5539 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5540 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5541 unobvious parameters.
5542
5543 Example :
5544 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5545 backend public_www
5546 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5547 stats enable
5548 stats hide-version
5549 stats scope .
5550 stats uri /admin?stats
5551 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5552 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5553 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5554
5555 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5556 backend private_monitoring
5557 stats enable
5558 stats uri /admin?stats
5559 stats refresh 5s
5560
5561 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5562
5563
5564stats enable
5565 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5567 yes | no | yes | yes
5568 Arguments : none
5569
5570 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5571 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5572 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5573 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5574 - stats auth : no authentication
5575 - stats scope : no restriction
5576
5577 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5578 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5579 unobvious parameters.
5580
5581 Example :
5582 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5583 backend public_www
5584 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5585 stats enable
5586 stats hide-version
5587 stats scope .
5588 stats uri /admin?stats
5589 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5590 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5591 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5592
5593 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5594 backend private_monitoring
5595 stats enable
5596 stats uri /admin?stats
5597 stats refresh 5s
5598
5599 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5600
5601
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005602stats hide-version
5603 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5605 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005606 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005607
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005608 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5609 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5610 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5611 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5612 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5613 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005614
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005615 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5616 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5617 unobvious parameters.
5618
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005619 Example :
5620 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5621 backend public_www
5622 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005623 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005624 stats hide-version
5625 stats scope .
5626 stats uri /admin?stats
5627 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5628 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5629 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005630
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005631 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5632 backend private_monitoring
5633 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005634 stats uri /admin?stats
5635 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005636
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005637 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005638
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005639
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005640stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5641 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5642 Access control for statistics
5643
5644 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5645 no | no | yes | yes
5646
5647 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5648 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5649 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5650 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5651 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5652 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5653
5654 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5655 instance.
5656
5657 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5658 about ACL usage.
5659
5660
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005661stats realm <realm>
5662 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5664 yes | no | yes | yes
5665 Arguments :
5666 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5667 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5668 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5669
5670 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5671 using a backslash ('\').
5672
5673 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5674 only related to authentication.
5675
5676 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5677 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5678 unobvious parameters.
5679
5680 Example :
5681 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5682 backend public_www
5683 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5684 stats enable
5685 stats hide-version
5686 stats scope .
5687 stats uri /admin?stats
5688 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5689 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5690 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5691
5692 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5693 backend private_monitoring
5694 stats enable
5695 stats uri /admin?stats
5696 stats refresh 5s
5697
5698 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5699
5700
5701stats refresh <delay>
5702 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5704 yes | no | yes | yes
5705 Arguments :
5706 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5707 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5708 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5709 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5710 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5711 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5712
5713 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5714 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5715 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5716 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5717
5718 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5719 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5720 unobvious parameters.
5721
5722 Example :
5723 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5724 backend public_www
5725 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5726 stats enable
5727 stats hide-version
5728 stats scope .
5729 stats uri /admin?stats
5730 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5731 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5732 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5733
5734 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5735 backend private_monitoring
5736 stats enable
5737 stats uri /admin?stats
5738 stats refresh 5s
5739
5740 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5741
5742
5743stats scope { <name> | "." }
5744 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5746 yes | no | yes | yes
5747 Arguments :
5748 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5749 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5750 section in which the statement appears.
5751
5752 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5753 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5754 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5755 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5756 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5757 exists.
5758
5759 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5760 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5761 unobvious parameters.
5762
5763 Example :
5764 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5765 backend public_www
5766 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5767 stats enable
5768 stats hide-version
5769 stats scope .
5770 stats uri /admin?stats
5771 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5772 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5773 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5774
5775 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5776 backend private_monitoring
5777 stats enable
5778 stats uri /admin?stats
5779 stats refresh 5s
5780
5781 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5782
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005783
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005784stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005785 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5787 yes | no | yes | yes
5788
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005789 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005790 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5791
5792 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5793 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5794
5795 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5796 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005797 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005798
5799 Example :
5800 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5801 backend private_monitoring
5802 stats enable
5803 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5804 stats uri /admin?stats
5805 stats refresh 5s
5806
5807 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5808 global section.
5809
5810
5811stats show-legends
5812 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5813 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5814 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5815 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5816 - IP (socket, server)
5817 - cookie (backend, server)
5818
5819 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5820 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005821 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005822
5823 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5824
5825
5826stats show-node [ <name> ]
5827 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5829 yes | no | yes | yes
5830 Arguments:
5831 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5832 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5833
5834 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5835 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005836 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005837
5838 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5839 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5840 unobvious parameters.
5841
5842 Example:
5843 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5844 backend private_monitoring
5845 stats enable
5846 stats show-node Europe-1
5847 stats uri /admin?stats
5848 stats refresh 5s
5849
5850 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5851 section.
5852
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005853
5854stats uri <prefix>
5855 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5857 yes | no | yes | yes
5858 Arguments :
5859 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5860 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5861 query string.
5862
5863 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5864 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5865 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5866 possible to reach it in the application.
5867
5868 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005869 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005870 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5871 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5872 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5873 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5874
5875 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5876 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5877 an address or a port to statistics only.
5878
5879 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5880 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5881 unobvious parameters.
5882
5883 Example :
5884 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5885 backend public_www
5886 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5887 stats enable
5888 stats hide-version
5889 stats scope .
5890 stats uri /admin?stats
5891 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5892 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5893 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5894
5895 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5896 backend private_monitoring
5897 stats enable
5898 stats uri /admin?stats
5899 stats refresh 5s
5900
5901 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5902
5903
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005904stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5905 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005907 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005908
5909 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02005910 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005911 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5912 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5913 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5914
5915 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5916 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5917 the "stick-table" statement.
5918
5919 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5920 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5921 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5922 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5923 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5924
5925 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5926 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5927 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5928 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5929 transformation rules.
5930
5931 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5932 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5933 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5934 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5935 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5936 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5937 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5938
5939 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5940 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5941 ACL based conditions.
5942
5943 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5944 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5945 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5946 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5947
5948 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5949 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5950 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5951 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5952
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005953 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5954 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5955 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5956
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005957 Example :
5958 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5959 # last 30 minutes
5960 backend pop
5961 mode tcp
5962 balance roundrobin
5963 stick store-request src
5964 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5965 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5966 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5967
5968 backend smtp
5969 mode tcp
5970 balance roundrobin
5971 stick match src table pop
5972 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5973 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5974
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005975 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5976 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005977
5978
5979stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5980 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5982 no | no | yes | yes
5983
5984 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5985 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5986 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5987 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5988
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005989 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5990 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5991 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5992
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005993 Examples :
5994 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005995 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005996
5997 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5998 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5999 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6000
6001
6002 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6003 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6004 backend http
6005 mode http
6006 balance roundrobin
6007 stick on src table https
6008 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6009 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6010 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6011
6012 backend https
6013 mode tcp
6014 balance roundrobin
6015 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6016 stick on src
6017 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6018 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6019
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006020 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006021
6022
6023stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6024 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6026 no | no | yes | yes
6027
6028 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006029 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006030 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6031 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6032 server is selected.
6033
6034 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6035 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6036 the "stick-table" statement.
6037
6038 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6039 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6040 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6041 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6042 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6043 address.
6044
6045 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6046 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6047 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6048 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6049 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6050 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6051 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6052 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6053 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6054 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6055
6056 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6057 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6058 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6059 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6060 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6061 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6062 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6063
6064 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6065 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6066 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6067 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6068
6069 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6070 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6071 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6072 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6073 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6074 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6075 another protocol or access method.
6076
6077 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6078 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6079 the request.
6080
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006081 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6082 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6083 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6084
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006085 Example :
6086 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6087 # last 30 minutes
6088 backend pop
6089 mode tcp
6090 balance roundrobin
6091 stick store-request src
6092 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6093 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6094 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6095
6096 backend smtp
6097 mode tcp
6098 balance roundrobin
6099 stick match src table pop
6100 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6101 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6102
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006103 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6104 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006105
6106
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006107stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006108 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6109 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006110 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
6111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006112 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006113
6114 Arguments :
6115 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6116 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6117 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6118 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6119
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006120 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6121 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6122 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6123 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6124
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006125 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6126 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6127 instance.
6128
6129 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6130 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6131 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6132 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6133 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6134 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006135 to 32 characters.
6136
6137 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6138 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6139 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6140 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6141 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6142 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006143
6144 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006145 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6146 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006147 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6148 increase.
6149
6150 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006151 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6152 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6153 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006154
6155 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6156 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6157 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6158 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6159 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6160 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6161 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6162 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6163 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6164 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6165 parameter (see below).
6166
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006167 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6168 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6169 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6170 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6171 soft restart.
6172
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006173 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6174
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006175 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6176 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6177 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6178 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6179 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006180 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006181 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6182 if not expiration delay is specified.
6183
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006184 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6185 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6186 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6187 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006188 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6189 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6190 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6191 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6192 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6193 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6194 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6195 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6196 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6197 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6198 types and their arguments.
6199
6200 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6201 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6202 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6203 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6204
6205 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6206 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6207 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6208 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6209
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006210 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6211 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6212 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6213 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6214 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6215 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6216
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006217 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6218 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6219 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6220 they were received.
6221
6222 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6223 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6224 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6225 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6226 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6227
6228 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6229 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6230 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6231 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6232 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6233
6234 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6235 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6236 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6237
6238 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6239 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6240 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6241 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6242 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6243
6244 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6245 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6246 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6247 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6248 the client side.
6249
6250 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6251 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6252 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6253 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6254 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6255 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6256 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6257
6258 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6259 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6260 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6261 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6262 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6263 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6264 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6265
6266 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6267 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6268 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6269 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6270 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6271 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6272
6273 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6274 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6275 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6276 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6277
6278 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6279 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6280 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6281 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6282 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6283 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6284 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6285 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6286 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6287 recommended for better fairness.
6288
6289 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6290 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6291 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6292 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6293
6294 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6295 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6296 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6297 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6298 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6299 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6300 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6301 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6302 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6303 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006304
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006305 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6306 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006307 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6308 reference it.
6309
6310 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6311 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6312 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6313 as an exclusive stickiness.
6314
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006315 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6316 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6317 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6318 something that can be ignored.
6319
6320 Example:
6321 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6322 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6323 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6324 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6325
6326 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006327 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006328
6329
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006330stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6331 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6333 no | no | yes | yes
6334
6335 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006336 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006337 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6338 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6339 server is selected.
6340
6341 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6342 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6343 the "stick-table" statement.
6344
6345 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6346 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6347 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6348 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6349
6350 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6351 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6352 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6353 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6354 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6355 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006356 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006357 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6358 rules.
6359
6360 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6361 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6362 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6363 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6364 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6365 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6366 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6367
6368 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6369 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6370 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6371 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6372
6373 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6374 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6375 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6376 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6377 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6378 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6379 another protocol or access method.
6380
6381 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6382
6383 Example :
6384 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6385 backend https
6386 mode tcp
6387 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006388 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006389 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006390
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006391 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6392 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6393
6394 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6395 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6396 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6397
6398 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6399 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006400
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006401 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6402 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6403 # at offset 44.
6404
6405 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6406 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6407
6408 # Learn on response if server hello.
6409 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006410
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006411 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6412 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6413
6414 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6415 extraction.
6416
6417
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006418tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6419 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6421 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006422 Arguments :
6423 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006424 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6425 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006426
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006427 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006428
6429 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6430 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006431 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6432 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6433 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6434 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6435 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6436 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006437
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006438 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6439 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6440 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6441 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006442
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006443 Three types of actions are supported :
6444 - accept :
6445 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6446 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6447 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006448
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006449 - reject :
6450 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6451 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6452 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6453 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6454 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6455 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6456 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6457 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6458 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6459 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6460 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6461 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006462
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006463 - expect-proxy layer4 :
6464 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
6465 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
6466 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
6467 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
6468 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
6469 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
6470 hosts.
6471
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006472 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006473 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6474 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6475 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006476 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6477 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006478 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006479 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
6480 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
6481 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
6482 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
6483 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006484
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006485 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006486 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006487 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006488 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6489 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6490 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6491 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006492
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006493 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6494 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6495 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6496 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006497
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006498 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6499 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6500 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6501 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6502 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006503 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6504 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6505 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6506 layer7 information is extracted.
6507
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006508 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6509 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6510 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6511 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6512 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006513
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006514 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6515 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6516 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006517
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006518 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6519 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6520 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006521
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006522 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006523 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006524 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006525
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006526 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6527 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6528 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006529
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006530 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006531 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6532 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006533
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006534 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
6535
6536 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
6537
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006538 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6539
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006540 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006541
6542
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006543tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6544 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006546 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006547 Arguments :
6548 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006549 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6550 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006551 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006552
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006553 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006554
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006555 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6556 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6557 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6558 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6559 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006560
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006561 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6562 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6563 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6564 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6565 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6566 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6567 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6568 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6569 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006570
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006571 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6572 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6573 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6574 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006575
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006576 Three types of actions are supported :
6577 - accept :
6578 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006579 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006580
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006581 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6582 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006583
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006584 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6585 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6586 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006587 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6588 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6589 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6590 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006591 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc0 pointer to track per-frontend
6592 counters and track-sc1 to track per-backend counters, but this is just a
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006593 guideline and all counters may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006594
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006595 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006596 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6597 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006598
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006599 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006600 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6601 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6602 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6603 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6604 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006605
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006606 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6607 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6608 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6609 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6610
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006611 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006612 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6613 # and reject everything else.
6614 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6615 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006616 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006617 tcp-request content reject
6618
6619 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006620 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6621 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6622 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006623 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006624
6625 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6626 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6627 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006628 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006629 tcp-request content reject
6630
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006631 Example:
6632 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6633 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006634 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006635
6636 Example:
6637 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6638 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006639 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006640
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006641 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6642 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6643
6644 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006645 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006646 # protecting all our sites
6647 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006648 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6649 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006650 ...
6651 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6652
6653 backend http_dynamic
6654 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006655 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006656 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006657 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
6658 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
6659 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006660 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006661
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006662 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006663
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006664 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006665
6666
6667tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6668 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006670 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006671 Arguments :
6672 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6673 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6674 as explained at the top of this document.
6675
6676 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6677 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6678 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6679 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6680 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6681
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006682 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6683 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6684 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6685 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6686
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006687 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6688 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006689 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006690 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006691 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6692 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6693 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6694 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006695
6696 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6697 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6698 it pass through unaffected.
6699
6700 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6701 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6702 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006703 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006704 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6705 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006706 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6707 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6708 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006709
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006710 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006711 "timeout client".
6712
6713
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006714tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6715 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6717 no | no | yes | yes
6718 Arguments :
6719 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6720 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6721 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6722
6723 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6724
6725 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6726 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6727 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6728 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006729 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006730
6731 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6732
6733 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6734 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6735 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6736 inserted.
6737
6738 Two types of actions are supported :
6739 - accept :
6740 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6741 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6742 the rules evaluation.
6743
6744 - reject :
6745 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6746 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006747 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006748
6749 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6750 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6751 for changing the default action to a reject.
6752
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006753 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6754 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6755 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6756 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006757 period.
6758
6759 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6760
6761 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6762
6763
6764tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6765 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6767 no | no | yes | yes
6768 Arguments :
6769 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6770 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6771 as explained at the top of this document.
6772
6773 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6774
6775
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006776timeout check <timeout>
6777 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6778 established.
6779
6780 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6781 yes | no | yes | yes
6782 Arguments:
6783 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6784 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6785 as explained at the top of this document.
6786
6787 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6788 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6789 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6790 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006791 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6792 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6793 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006794
6795 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6796 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6797
6798 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6799 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006800 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006801
6802 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6803 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6804 forget about it.
6805
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006806 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6807 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006808
6809
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006810timeout client <timeout>
6811timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6812 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6814 yes | yes | yes | no
6815 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006816 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006817 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6818 as explained at the top of this document.
6819
6820 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6821 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6822 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6823 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6824 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6825 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6826 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6827 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006828 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006829 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006830 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6831 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6832 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006833
6834 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6835 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6836 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6837 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6838 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6839 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6840
6841 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6842 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6843 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6844
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006845 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006846
6847
6848timeout connect <timeout>
6849timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6850 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6852 yes | no | yes | yes
6853 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006854 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006855 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6856 as explained at the top of this document.
6857
6858 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006859 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006860 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006861 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006862 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6863 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006864
6865 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6866 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6867 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6868 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6869 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6870 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6871
6872 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6873 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6874 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6875
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006876 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6877 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006878
6879
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006880timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6881 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6883 yes | yes | yes | yes
6884 Arguments :
6885 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6886 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6887 as explained at the top of this document.
6888
6889 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6890 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6891 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6892 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6893 once the request has started to present itself.
6894
6895 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6896 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6897 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6898 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6899 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6900
6901 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6902 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6903 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6904 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6905
6906 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6907 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6908 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6909 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6910 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006911 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006912
6913 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6914 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6915 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6916 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6917
6918 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6919
6920
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006921timeout http-request <timeout>
6922 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006924 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006925 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006926 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006927 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6928 as explained at the top of this document.
6929
6930 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6931 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6932 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6933 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6934 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6935 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6936 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6937 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6938
6939 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6940 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006941 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6942 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006943
6944 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6945 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6946 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6947 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6948 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6949
6950 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006951 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6952 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6953 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006954
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006955 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006956
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006957
6958timeout queue <timeout>
6959 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6961 yes | no | yes | yes
6962 Arguments :
6963 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6964 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6965 as explained at the top of this document.
6966
6967 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6968 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6969 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6970 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6971 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6972
6973 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6974 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6975 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6976 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6977
6978 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6979
6980
6981timeout server <timeout>
6982timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6983 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6985 yes | no | yes | yes
6986 Arguments :
6987 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6988 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6989 as explained at the top of this document.
6990
6991 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6992 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6993 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6994 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6995 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6996 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6997 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6998
6999 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7000 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7001 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7002 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7003 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007004 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007005 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007006 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7007 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7008 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7009 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007010
7011 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7012 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7013 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7014 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7015 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7016 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7017
7018 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7019 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7020 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7021
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007022 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007023
7024
7025timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007026 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7028 yes | yes | yes | yes
7029 Arguments :
7030 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7031 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7032 as explained at the top of this document.
7033
7034 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7035 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7036 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7037
7038 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7039 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7040 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7041 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007042 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007043
7044 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7045
7046
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007047timeout tunnel <timeout>
7048 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7050 yes | no | yes | yes
7051 Arguments :
7052 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7053 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7054 as explained at the top of this document.
7055
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007056 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007057 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7058 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7059 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7060 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7061 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7062 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7063 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7064 specified.
7065
7066 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7067 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7068 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7069 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7070 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7071
7072 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7073 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7074 forget about it.
7075
7076 Example :
7077 defaults http
7078 option http-server-close
7079 timeout connect 5s
7080 timeout client 30s
7081 timeout client 30s
7082 timeout server 30s
7083 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7084
7085 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7086
7087
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007088transparent (deprecated)
7089 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007091 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007092 Arguments : none
7093
7094 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7095 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7096 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7097 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7098 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7099 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7100 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7101 appropriate server.
7102
7103 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7104
7105 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7106 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7107
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007108 See also: "option transparent"
7109
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007110unique-id-format <string>
7111 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7113 yes | yes | yes | no
7114 Arguments :
7115 <string> is a log-format string.
7116
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007117 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7118 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7119 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7120 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007121
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007122 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7123 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7124 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7125 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7126 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7127 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7128 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7129 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007130
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007131 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7132 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007133
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007134 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007135
7136 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7137
7138 will generate:
7139
7140 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7141
7142 See also: "unique-id-header"
7143
7144unique-id-header <name>
7145 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7147 yes | yes | yes | no
7148 Arguments :
7149 <name> is the name of the header.
7150
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007151 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7152 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007153
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007154 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007155
7156 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7157 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7158
7159 will generate:
7160
7161 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7162
7163 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007164
7165use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7166use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007167 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7169 no | yes | yes | no
7170 Arguments :
7171 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
7172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007173 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007174
7175 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7176 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7177 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007178 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7179 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7180 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7181 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007182
7183 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7184 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7185 assign the backend.
7186
7187 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7188 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7189 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7190 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7191 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7192 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7193
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007194 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007195 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007196 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7197 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7198 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7199
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007200 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007201
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007202
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007203use-server <server> if <condition>
7204use-server <server> unless <condition>
7205 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7207 no | no | yes | yes
7208 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007209 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007210
7211 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7212
7213 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7214 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7215 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7216
7217 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7218 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7219 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7220 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7221 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7222 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7223 matches will assign the server.
7224
7225 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7226 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7227 with the next rules until one matches.
7228
7229 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7230 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7231 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7232 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7233
7234 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7235 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7236 stripped.
7237
7238 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7239 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7240 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7241 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7242
7243 Example :
7244 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7245 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7246 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7247 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7248 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7249 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7250 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7251 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7252 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7253
7254 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7255
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007256
72575. Bind and Server options
7258--------------------------
7259
7260The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7261depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7262settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7263written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7264described in this section.
7265
7266
72675.1. Bind options
7268-----------------
7269
7270The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7271as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7272no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7273parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7274while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7275provided immediately after the setting name.
7276
7277The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7278
7279accept-proxy
7280 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7281 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7282 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7283 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7284 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7285 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7286 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7287 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7288 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007289 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7290 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007291
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007292alpn <protocols>
7293 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7294 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7295 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7296 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7297 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7298 initial NPN extension.
7299
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007300backlog <backlog>
7301 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7302 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7303
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007304ecdhe <named curve>
7305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007306 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7307 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007308
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007309ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007310 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7311 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7312 client's certificate.
7313
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007314ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7315 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7316 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7317 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7318 error is ignored.
7319
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007320ciphers <ciphers>
7321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7322 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7323 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7324 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7325 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7326
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007327crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007328 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7329 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7330 to verify client's certificate.
7331
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007332crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007333 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7334 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7335 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7336 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7337 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7338 file.
7339
7340 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7341 are loaded.
7342
7343 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7344 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7345 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7346 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7347 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7348 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7349 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7350 www.sub.example.org).
7351
7352 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7353 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7354 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7355 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7356 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7357
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007358 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007359
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007360 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7361 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
7362 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires a intermediate CA (for
7363 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7364 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7365 clients).
7366
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007367crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007368 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7369 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
7370 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an error
7371 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007372
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007373crt-list <file>
7374 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007375 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7376 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007377
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007378 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007379
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007380 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7381 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7382 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7383 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7384 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7385 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7386 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7387 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007388
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007389defer-accept
7390 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7391 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7392 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7393 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7394 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7395 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7396 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7397 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7398 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7399 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7400 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7401
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007402force-sslv3
7403 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7404 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7405 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7406
7407force-tlsv10
7408 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7409 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7410
7411force-tlsv11
7412 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7413 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7414
7415force-tlsv12
7416 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7417 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7418
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007419gid <gid>
7420 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7421 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7422 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7423 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7424 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7425
7426group <group>
7427 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7428 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7429 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7430 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7431 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7432
7433id <id>
7434 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7435 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7436 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7437 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7438
7439interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007440 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7441 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7442 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7443 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7444 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7445 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7446 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007447
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007448level <level>
7449 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7450 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7451 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7452 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7453 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7454 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7455 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7456 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7457 counters).
7458 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7459 all counters).
7460
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007461maxconn <maxconn>
7462 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7463 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7464 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7465 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7466 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7467 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7468 eat all memory.
7469
7470mode <mode>
7471 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7472 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7473 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7474 UNIX sockets.
7475
7476mss <maxseg>
7477 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7478 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7479 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7480 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7481 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7482 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7483 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7484 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7485 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7486 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7487 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7488
7489name <name>
7490 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7491 page.
7492
7493nice <nice>
7494 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7495 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7496 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7497 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7498 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7499 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7500 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7501 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7502 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7503 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7504 one for an RDP socket.
7505
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007506no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007507 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7508 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7509 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007510 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7511 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007512
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007513no-tls-tickets
7514 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7515 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7516 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7517 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7518
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007519no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007520 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007521 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7522 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7523 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7524 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007525
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007526no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007528 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7529 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7530 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7531 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007532
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007533no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007534 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007535 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7536 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7537 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7538 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007539
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007540npn <protocols>
7541 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7542 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7543 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7544 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007545 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
7546 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007547
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007548ssl
7549 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7550 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7551 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7552 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7553 to deciphered contents.
7554
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01007555strict-sni
7556 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
7557 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
7558 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
7559 See the "crt" option for more information.
7560
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007561tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01007562 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007563 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7564 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7565 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7566 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7567 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7568 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7569 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02007570 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
7571 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
7572 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007573
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007574transparent
7575 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7576 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7577 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7578 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7579 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7580 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7581 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7582 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7583 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7584 so check for support with your vendor.
7585
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007586v4v6
7587 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7588 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7589 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7590 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7591 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7592
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007593v6only
7594 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7595 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7596 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007597 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7598 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007599
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007600uid <uid>
7601 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7602 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7603 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7604 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7605 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7606
7607user <user>
7608 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7609 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7610 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7611 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7612 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7613
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007614verify [none|optional|required]
7615 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7616 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7617 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7618 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7619 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007620 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7621 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7622 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7623 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007624
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020076255.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007626------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007627
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007628The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7629which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7630arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7631settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7632after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7633Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7634address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007636 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007637 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007638
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007639The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007640
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007641addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007642 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7643 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7644 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7645 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7646 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007647
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007648 Supported in default-server: No
7649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007650backup
7651 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7652 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7653 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7654 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7655 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7656 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007658 Supported in default-server: No
7659
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007660ca-file <cafile>
7661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7662 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7663 server's certificate.
7664
7665 Supported in default-server: No
7666
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007667check
7668 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007669 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7670 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7671 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7672 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7673 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7674 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7675 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09007676 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the
7677 "httpchk", "lb-agent-chk", "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and
7678 "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and parameters for
7679 more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007680
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007681 Supported in default-server: No
7682
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007683check-send-proxy
7684 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7685 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7686 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7687 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7688 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7689 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7690 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7691
7692 Supported in default-server: No
7693
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007694check-ssl
7695 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7696 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7697 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7698 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7699 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7700 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7701 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7702 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7703 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7704
7705 Supported in default-server: No
7706
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007707ciphers <ciphers>
7708 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7709 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7710 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7711 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7712 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7713 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7714 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7715 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7716
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007717 Supported in default-server: No
7718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007719cookie <value>
7720 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7721 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7722 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7723 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7724 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7725 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7726 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7727
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007728 Supported in default-server: No
7729
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007730crl-file <crlfile>
7731 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7732 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7733 to verify server's certificate.
7734
7735 Supported in default-server: No
7736
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007737crt <cert>
7738 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7739 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7740 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7741 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7742 certificate request.
7743
7744 Supported in default-server: No
7745
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007746disabled
7747 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7748 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7749 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7750 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7751 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7752
7753 Supported in default-server: No
7754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007755error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007756 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7757 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7758 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007759
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007760 Supported in default-server: Yes
7761
7762 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007764fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007765 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7766 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7767 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007769 Supported in default-server: Yes
7770
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007771force-sslv3
7772 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7773 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7774 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7775
7776 Supported in default-server: No
7777
7778force-tlsv10
7779 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7780 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7781
7782 Supported in default-server: No
7783
7784force-tlsv11
7785 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7786 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7787
7788 Supported in default-server: No
7789
7790force-tlsv12
7791 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7792 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7793
7794 Supported in default-server: No
7795
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007796id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007797 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7798 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7799 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007801 Supported in default-server: No
7802
7803inter <delay>
7804fastinter <delay>
7805downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007806 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7807 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7808 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7809 between checks depending on the server state :
7810
7811 Server state | Interval used
7812 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7813 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7814 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7815 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7816 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7817 or yet unchecked. |
7818 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7819 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7820 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007821
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007822 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7823 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7824 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7825 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7826 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7827 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7828 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7829 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7830 servers.
7831
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007832 Supported in default-server: Yes
7833
7834maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007835 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7836 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7837 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7838 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7839 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7840 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7841 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7842 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7843
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007844 Supported in default-server: Yes
7845
7846maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007847 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7848 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7849 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7850 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7851 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7852 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7853 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7854
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007855 Supported in default-server: Yes
7856
7857minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007858 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7859 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7860 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7861 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7862 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7863 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007864 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007865 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007867 Supported in default-server: Yes
7868
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007869no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007870 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7871 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007872 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007873
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007874 Supported in default-server: No
7875
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007876no-tls-tickets
7877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7878 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7879 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7880 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7881
7882 Supported in default-server: No
7883
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007884no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007885 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007886 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7887 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007888 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7889 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007890
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007891 Supported in default-server: No
7892
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007893no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007894 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007895 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7896 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007897 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7898 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007899
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007900 Supported in default-server: No
7901
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007902no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007903 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007904 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7905 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007906 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7907 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007908
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007909 Supported in default-server: No
7910
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007911non-stick
7912 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7913 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7914 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7915
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007916 Supported in default-server: No
7917
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007918observe <mode>
7919 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7920 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7921 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7922 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7923 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7924 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007925 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007927 Supported in default-server: No
7928
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007929 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7930
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007931on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007932 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7933 Currently, four modes are available:
7934 - fastinter: force fastinter
7935 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7936 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7937 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7938 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7939
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007940 Supported in default-server: Yes
7941
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007942 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7943
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007944on-marked-down <action>
7945 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7946 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007947 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7948 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7949 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7950 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7951 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7952 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7953 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7954 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007955
7956 Actions are disabled by default
7957
7958 Supported in default-server: Yes
7959
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007960on-marked-up <action>
7961 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7962 Currently one action is available:
7963 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7964 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7965 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7966 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7967 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7968 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7969 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7970 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7971
7972 Actions are disabled by default
7973
7974 Supported in default-server: Yes
7975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007976port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007977 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7978 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7979 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7980 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7981 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7982 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007984 Supported in default-server: Yes
7985
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007986redir <prefix>
7987 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7988 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7989 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7990 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7991 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7992 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7993 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7994 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007995 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007996 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7997 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7998 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7999 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8000 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8001
8002 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8003
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008004 Supported in default-server: No
8005
8006rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008007 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8008 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8009 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8010
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008011 Supported in default-server: Yes
8012
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008013send-proxy
8014 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8015 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8016 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8017 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8018 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8019 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8020 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8021 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8022 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008023 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8024 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8025 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8026 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8027 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008028
8029 Supported in default-server: No
8030
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008031slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008032 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8033 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8034 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8035 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8036 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8037 parameters :
8038
8039 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8040 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8041
8042 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8043 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8044 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8045 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8046
8047 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8048 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8049 seen as failed.
8050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008051 Supported in default-server: Yes
8052
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008053source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008054source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008055source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008056 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8057 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8058 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8059 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8060
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008061 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8062 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8063 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8064 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8065 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8066 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8067 server.
8068
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008069 Supported in default-server: No
8070
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008071ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008072 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
8073 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
8074 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
8075 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
8076 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
8077 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
8078 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
8079 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
8080
8081 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008083track [<proxy>/]<server>
8084 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8085 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8086 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8087 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8088 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8089
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008090 Supported in default-server: No
8091
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008092verify [none|required]
8093 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8094 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
8095 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
8096 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8097 is aborted.
8098
8099 Supported in default-server: No
8100
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008101weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008102 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8103 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8104 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008105 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8106 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8107 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8108 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8109 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8110 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008111
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008112 Supported in default-server: Yes
8113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008114
81156. HTTP header manipulation
8116---------------------------
8117
8118In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8119response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8120request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8121which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
8122against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
8123to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
8124passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
8125headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
8126never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
8127
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008128There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
8129(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
8130rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
8131messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
8132in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008133happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008134add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
8135normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
8136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008137This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8138in section 4.2 :
8139
8140 - reqadd <string>
8141 - reqallow <search>
8142 - reqiallow <search>
8143 - reqdel <search>
8144 - reqidel <search>
8145 - reqdeny <search>
8146 - reqideny <search>
8147 - reqpass <search>
8148 - reqipass <search>
8149 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8150 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8151 - reqtarpit <search>
8152 - reqitarpit <search>
8153 - rspadd <string>
8154 - rspdel <search>
8155 - rspidel <search>
8156 - rspdeny <search>
8157 - rspideny <search>
8158 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8159 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8160
8161With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8162is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8163parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8164prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8165Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8166
8167 \t for a tab
8168 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8169 \n for a new line (LF)
8170 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8171 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8172 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8173 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8174 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8175
8176The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8177portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8178above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8179regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
81809 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8181is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8182
8183The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8184after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8185
8186Notes related to these keywords :
8187---------------------------------
8188 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8189 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8190 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8191
8192 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8193 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8194 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8195
8196 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8197 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8198 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8199 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8200 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8201
8202 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8203 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8204 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8205 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8206 useless headers before adding new ones.
8207
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008208 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008209 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8210
8211 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8212 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8213 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8214
8215 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8216 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008217 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008218
8219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020082207. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8221----------------------------------
8222
8223Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8224client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8225The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8226these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8227but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8228data called patterns.
8229
8230
82317.1. ACL basics
8232---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008233
8234The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8235content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8236from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8237simple :
8238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008239 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
8240 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8241 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008243The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8244adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008245
8246In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008248 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008249
8250This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8251Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8252and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
8253an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
8254of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
8255
8256ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8257'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8258which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8259
8260There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8261performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008263The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8264specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8265this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
8266methods of a same sample fetch method.
8267
8268Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8269 - boolean
8270 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8271 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8272 - string
8273 - data block
8274
8275The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8276 - boolean
8277 - integer or integer range
8278 - IP address / network
8279 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8280 - regular expression
8281 - hex block
8282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008283The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8284
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008285 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8286 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008287 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008288 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008290The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8291read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8292if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8293lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8294will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8295beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8296a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8297lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8298exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8299
8300Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8301loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8302
8303 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8304
8305In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8306the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8307case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8308as well.
8309
8310The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8311sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8312do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8313methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8314is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8315obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8316followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8317default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8318that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8319string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8320
8321There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8322sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8323be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008324
8325 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8326 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008327 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8328 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8329 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8330 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008331
8332 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
8333 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008334 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008335
8336 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008337 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008338
8339 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008340 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008341
8342 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
8343 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
8344
8345 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
8346 binary or string samples.
8347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008348 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
8349 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008351 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
8352 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
8353 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008355 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
8356 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008358 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
8359 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008361 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
8362 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008364 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
8365 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008366 This may be used with binary or string samples.
8367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008368 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
8369 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
8370 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008371
8372For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
8373request, it is possible to do :
8374
8375 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
8376
8377In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
8378buffer, one would use the following acl :
8379
8380 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
8381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008382All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
8383criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
8384method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
8385to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
8386criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
8387the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008389If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
8390the mathing method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method. For
8391example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008393 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
8394 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
8395 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
8396 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008397
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008399The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample fetch types
8400and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
8401combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
8402the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008404 +-------------------------------------------------+
8405 | Input sample type |
8406 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8407 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
8408 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8409 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
8410 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8411 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | | |
8412 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8413 | integer (value) | int | *int | | | |
8414 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8415 | integer (length) | | | | len | len |
8416 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8417 | IP address | | | *ip | | |
8418 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8419 | exact string | | | | str | str |
8420 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8421 | prefix | | | | beg | beg |
8422 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8423 | suffix | | | | end | end |
8424 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8425 | substring | | | | sub | sub |
8426 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8427 | subdir | | | | dir | dir |
8428 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8429 | domain | | | | dom | dom |
8430 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8431 | regex | | | | reg | reg |
8432 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8433 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
8434 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008435
8436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020084377.1.1. Matching booleans
8438------------------------
8439
8440In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
8441Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
8442When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
8443that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
8444
8445Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
8446return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
8447"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
8448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020084507.1.2. Matching integers
8451------------------------
8452
8453Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
8454enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
8455to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
8456
8457Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
8458matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
8459lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008460
8461For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
8462unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
8463representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
8464
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008465As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
8466two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
8467instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
8468ranges and operators.
8469
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008470For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008471operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
8472Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
8473of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008474
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008475Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008476
8477 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
8478 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
8479 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
8480 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
8481 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
8482
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008483For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008484
8485 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8486
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008487This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8488
8489 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8490
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020084927.1.3. Matching strings
8493-----------------------
8494
8495String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
8496different forms :
8497
8498 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
8499 patterns ;
8500
8501 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
8502 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
8503
8504 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
8505 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8506
8507 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
8508 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8509
8510 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8511 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
8512 matches.
8513
8514 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8515 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
8516 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008517
8518String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
8519exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
8520characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
8521string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
8522to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008523before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008524
8525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085267.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
8527---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008528
8529Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
8530they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8531possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8532passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8533the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008534the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8535match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008536
8537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085387.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
8539-------------------------------------
8540
8541It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
8542not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
8543a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
8544to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
8545digits may be used upper or lower case.
8546
8547Example :
8548 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
8549 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
8550
8551
85527.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
8553---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008554
8555IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
8556netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
8557within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008558host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008559difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
8560at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
8561does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
8562parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008563
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008564IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
8565Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
8566trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
8567IPv6 patterns.
8568
8569HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
8570following situations :
8571 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
8572 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
8573 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
8574 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
8575 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
8576 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
8577 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
8578 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
8579 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
8580 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
8581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008582
85837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
8584----------------------------------
8585
8586Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8587combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
8588
8589 - AND (implicit)
8590 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8591 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008593A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008595 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02008596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008597Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8598indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02008599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008600For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8601"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8602requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8603is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
8604
8605 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8606 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8607 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8608 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
8609
8610To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8611and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
8612
8613 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8614 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8615 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8616 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
8617
8618 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8619 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8620 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8621 use_backend www if host_www
8622
8623It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8624expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8625be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
8626the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
8627
8628 The following rule :
8629
8630 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8631 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8632
8633 Can also be written that way :
8634
8635 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8636
8637It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8638to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8639simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8640sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8641good use is the following :
8642
8643 With named ACLs :
8644
8645 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8646 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8647 monitor fail if site_dead
8648
8649 With anonymous ACLs :
8650
8651 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8652
8653See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
8654
8655
86567.3. Fetching samples
8657---------------------
8658
8659Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
8660against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
8661sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
8662ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
8663of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
8664available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
8665
8666This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
8667Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
8668compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
8669deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
8670
8671The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
8672matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
8673method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
8674indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
8675
8676As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
8677when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
8678mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
8679the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
8680ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
8681
8682Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
8683multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
8684when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
8685incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
8686are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
8687is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
8688all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
8689
8690Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
8691 - name
8692 - name(arg1)
8693 - name(arg1,arg2)
8694
8695At the moment, the stickiness features are the most advanced users of the
8696sample fetch system. The "stick on", and "stick store-request" directives
8697support sample fetch rules which allow a list of transformations to be applied
8698on top of the fetched sample, and the finaly result is automatically converted
8699to the type of the table. These transformations are enumerated as a series
8700of specific keywords after the sample fetch method. These keywords can also
8701support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008703The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008705 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
8706 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
8707 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008709 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
8710 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
8711 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008713 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
8714 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
8715 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8716 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8717 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8718
8719
87207.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
8721--------------------------------------------
8722
8723A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
8724not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
8725"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
8726The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
8727
8728always_false : boolean
8729 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
8730 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8731
8732always_true : boolean
8733 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
8734 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8735
8736avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008737 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008738 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
8739 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
8740 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
8741 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
8742 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
8743 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
8744 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
8745 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
8746 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
8747 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
8748 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
8749 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
8750 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01008751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008752be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008753 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
8754 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
8755 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8756 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
8757 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008759be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
8760 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
8761 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
8762 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
8763 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
8764 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
8765 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008766
8767 Example :
8768 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
8769 backend dynamic
8770 mode http
8771 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
8772 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008774connslots([<backend>]) : integer
8775 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
8776 still available in the backend, by totalizing the maximum amount of
8777 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
8778 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05008779
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008780 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008781 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008782 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
8783
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008784 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
8785 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008786
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008787 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008788 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008789 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008790 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
8791 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008792 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008793 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008794
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008795 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
8796 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008797 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008798 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008799
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02008800env(<name>) : string
8801 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
8802 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
8803 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
8804 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
8805 certain way.
8806
8807 Examples :
8808 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
8809 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
8810
8811 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
8812 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
8813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008814fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
8815 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008816 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
8817 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008818 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
8819 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
8820 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
8821 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
8822 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008824fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
8825 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
8826 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
8827 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
8828 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
8829 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
8830 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
8831 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
8832 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008833
8834 Example :
8835 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
8836 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
8837 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
8838 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
8839 frontend mail
8840 bind :25
8841 mode tcp
8842 maxconn 100
8843 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
8844 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
8845 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
8846 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008848nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
8849 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
8850 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
8851 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008852 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8853 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8854 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008856queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008857 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8858 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8859 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008860 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
8861 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
8862 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
8863 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
8864 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
8865
8866srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
8867 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
8868 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
8869 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
8870 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
8871 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
8872 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
8873 methods.
8874
8875srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
8876 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8877 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8878 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
8879 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
8880 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
8881 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
8882 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8883
8884srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
8885 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
8886 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
8887 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mosly
8888 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
8889 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
8890 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
8891 overloading servers).
8892
8893 Example :
8894 # Redirect to a separate back
8895 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
8896 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
8897 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
8898
8899table_avl([<table>]) : integer
8900 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8901 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8902
8903table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
8904 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8905 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8906 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8907
8908
89097.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
8910----------------------------------
8911
8912The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
8913closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
8914methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
8915sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
8916TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
8917the incoming connection.
8918
8919be_id : integer
8920 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
8921 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
8922
8923dst : ip
8924 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
8925 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
8926 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8927 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
8928 RFC 4291.
8929
8930dst_conn : integer
8931 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
8932 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
8933 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
8934 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
8935 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
8936 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
8937 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
8938 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008940dst_port : integer
8941 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
8942 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
8943 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
8944 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
8945 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
8946 an HTTP header.
8947
8948fe_id : integer
8949 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
8950 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
8951 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
8952
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008953sc0_bytes_in_rate : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008954sc1_bytes_in_rate : integer
8955sc2_bytes_in_rate : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008956 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
8957 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8958 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
8959
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008960sc0_bytes_out_rate : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008961sc1_bytes_out_rate : integer
8962sc2_bytes_out_rate : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008963 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
8964 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8965 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
8966
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008967sc0_clr_gpc0 : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008968sc1_clr_gpc0 : integer
8969sc2_clr_gpc0 : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008970 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
8971 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01008972 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
8973 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8974 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008975
8976 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8977 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008978 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
8979 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8980 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008981 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8982 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8983
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008984sc0_conn_cnt : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008985sc1_conn_cnt : integer
8986sc2_conn_cnt : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008987 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
8988 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
8989
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008990sc0_conn_cur : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008991sc1_conn_cur : integer
8992sc2_conn_cur : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008993 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8994 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8995 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
8996
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008997sc0_conn_rate : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008998sc1_conn_rate : integer
8999sc2_conn_rate : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009000 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9001 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9002 See also src_conn_rate.
9003
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009004sc0_get_gpc0 : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009005sc1_get_gpc0 : integer
9006sc2_get_gpc0 : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009007 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009008 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009009
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009010sc0_gpc0_rate : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009011sc1_gpc0_rate : integer
9012sc2_gpc0_rate : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009013 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9014 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9015 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009016 src_gpc0_rate, sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note that the
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009017 "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to be
9018 returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009019
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009020sc0_http_err_cnt : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009021sc1_http_err_cnt : integer
9022sc2_http_err_cnt : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009023 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9024 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9025 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9026
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009027sc0_http_err_rate : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009028sc1_http_err_rate : integer
9029sc2_http_err_rate : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009030 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9031 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9032 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9033 src_http_err_rate.
9034
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009035sc0_http_req_cnt : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009036sc1_http_req_cnt : integer
9037sc2_http_req_cnt : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009038 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9039 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9040 src_http_req_cnt.
9041
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009042sc0_http_req_rate : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009043sc1_http_req_rate : integer
9044sc2_http_req_rate : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009045 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9046 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9047 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9048 src_http_req_rate.
9049
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009050sc0_inc_gpc0 : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009051sc1_inc_gpc0 : integer
9052sc2_inc_gpc0 : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009053 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009054 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9055 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9056 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9057 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009058
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009059 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9060 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009061 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9062
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009063sc0_kbytes_in : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009064sc1_kbytes_in : integer
9065sc2_kbytes_in : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009066 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9067 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9068 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9069 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9070
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009071sc0_kbytes_out : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009072sc1_kbytes_out : integer
9073sc2_kbytes_out : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009074 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9075 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9076 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9077 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9078
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009079sc0_sess_cnt : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009080sc1_sess_cnt : integer
9081sc2_sess_cnt : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009082 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9083 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9084 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9085 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009086 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009087 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9088
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009089sc0_sess_rate : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009090sc1_sess_rate : integer
9091sc2_sess_rate : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009092 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9093 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9094 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9095 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9096 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009097 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009098
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009099sc0_tracked : boolean
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009100sc1_tracked : boolean
9101sc2_tracked : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009102 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9103 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9104 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9105
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009106sc0_trackers : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009107sc1_trackers : integer
9108sc2_trackers : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009109 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9110 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009111 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009112 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9113 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009114 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9115 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9116 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009118so_id : integer
9119 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9120 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9121 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009123src : ip
9124 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9125 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9126 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9127 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9128 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9129 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9130 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009132src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9133 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9134 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9135 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009136 not found, zero is returned. See also sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009138src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9139 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9140 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009141 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009142 not found, zero is returned. See also sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009144src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9145 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9146 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9147 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9148 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9149 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9150 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009151
9152 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9153 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9154 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9155 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009156 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009157 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9158 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009160src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009161 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009162 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009163 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009164 See also sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009166src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009167 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009168 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9169 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009170 zero is returned. See also sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009172src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9173 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
9174 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9175 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009176 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009178src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009179 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009180 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009181 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009182 See also sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009184src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009185 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009186 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009187 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
9188 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009189 sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note that the
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009190 "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to be
9191 returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
9192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009193src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9194 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
9195 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009196 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009197 See also sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009198 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009200src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9201 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
9202 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9203 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9204 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009205 not found, zero is returned. See also sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009207src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9208 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9209 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9210 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009211 not found, zero is returned. See also sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009213src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9214 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9215 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9216 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009217 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009218 not found, zero is returned. See also sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009220src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9221 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9222 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9223 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009224 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009225 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
9226 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009227
9228 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009229 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009230 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009232src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9233 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
9234 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9235 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
9236 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009237 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009239src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9240 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
9241 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009242 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
9243 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009244 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009246src_port : integer
9247 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
9248 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
9249 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
9250 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009252src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9253 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009254 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9255 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
9256 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009257 is returned. See also sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009259src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9260 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
9261 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9262 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9263 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009264 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009266src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9267 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
9268 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
9269 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
9270 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
9271 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
9272 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
9273 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
9274 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009275
9276 Example :
9277 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
9278 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
9279 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
9280 listen ssh
9281 bind :22
9282 mode tcp
9283 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009284 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009285 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009286 server local 127.0.0.1:22
9287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009288srv_id : integer
9289 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
9290 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
9291 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02009292
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01009293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092947.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
9295----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02009296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009297The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
9298closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
9299when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
9300usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
9301future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negociations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009303ssl_c_ca_err : integer
9304 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9305 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
9306 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
9307 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
9308 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009310ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
9311 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9312 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
9313 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
9314 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009316ssl_c_err : integer
9317 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9318 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
9319 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
9320 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
9321 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009323ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9324 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9325 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9326 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9327 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9328 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9329 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9330 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9331 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009333 ACL derivatives :
9334 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009336ssl_c_key_alg : string
9337 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9338 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9339 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009341 ACL derivatives :
9342 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009344ssl_c_notafter : string
9345 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
9346 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9347 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009349 ACL derivatives :
9350 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009352ssl_c_notbefore : string
9353 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
9354 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9355 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009357 ACL derivatives :
9358 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009360ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9361 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9362 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9363 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9364 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9365 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9366 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9367 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9368 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009370 ACL derivatives :
9371 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009373ssl_c_serial : binary
9374 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
9375 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9376 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009378 ACL derivatives :
9379 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009381ssl_c_sha1 : binary
9382 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
9383 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
9384 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009386ssl_c_sig_alg : string
9387 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9388 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9389 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009391 ACL derivatives :
9392 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
9393
9394ssl_c_used : boolean
9395 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
9396 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009398ssl_c_verify : integer
9399 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
9400 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
9401 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
9402 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009404ssl_c_version : integer
9405 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
9406 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009408ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9409 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9410 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9411 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9412 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009413 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009414 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9415 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9416 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009418 ACL derivatives :
9419 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009421ssl_f_key_alg : string
9422 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9423 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
9424 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009426 ACL derivatives :
9427 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009429ssl_f_notafter : string
9430 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9431 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9432 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009434 ACL derivatives :
9435 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009437ssl_f_notbefore : string
9438 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9439 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9440 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009442 ACL derivatives :
9443 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009445ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9446 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9447 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9448 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9449 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9450 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9451 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9452 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9453 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009455 ACL derivatives :
9456 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009458ssl_f_serial : binary
9459 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9460 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9461 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009463 ACL derivatives :
9464 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009466ssl_f_sig_alg : string
9467 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9468 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9469 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009471 ACL derivatives :
9472 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009474ssl_f_version : integer
9475 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9476 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9477
9478ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009479 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9480 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
9481 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
9482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009483 Example :
9484 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
9485 listen http-https
9486 bind :80
9487 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
9488 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
9489
9490ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
9491 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
9492 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9493
9494ssl_fc_alpn : string
9495 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negociation field from an
9496 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
9497 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
9498 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
9499 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
9500 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
9501 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
9502 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
9503 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
9504
9505 ACL derivatives :
9506 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009508ssl_fc_cipher : string
9509 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
9510 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009512 ACL derivatives :
9513 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009515ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009516 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
9517 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009518 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
9519 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
9520 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
9521 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009523ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
9524 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009525 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
9526 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
9527 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9528 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009530ssl_fc_npn : string
9531 This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an incoming connection
9532 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
9533 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
9534 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9535 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
9536 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
9537 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
9538 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009540 ACL derivatives :
9541 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009543ssl_fc_protocol : string
9544 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
9545 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009547 ACL derivatives :
9548 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
9549
9550ssl_fc_session_id : binary
9551 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
9552 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
9553 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
9554 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009556ssl_fc_sni : string
9557 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
9558 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9559 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
9560 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
9561 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
9562
9563 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
9564 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
9565 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02009566 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
9567 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009569 ACL derivatives :
9570 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
9571 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
9572 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009574ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
9575 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
9576 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009577
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095797.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
9580------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009582Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
9583sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
9584only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
9585For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
9586be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
9587can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
9588sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
9589for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
9590content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009592payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
9593 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
9594 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
9595 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009597payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
9598 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
9599 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
9600 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009602req.len : integer
9603req_len : integer (deprecated)
9604 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
9605 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
9606 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
9607 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
9608 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
9609 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
9610 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
9611 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009613req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
9614 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
9615 in the request buffer.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009617 ACL alternatives :
9618 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009620req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
9621 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9622 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9623 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
9624 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009626 ACL alternatives :
9627 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009629 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009631req.proto_http : boolean
9632req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
9633 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
9634 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
9635 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
9636 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
9637 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
9638 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
9639 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009641 Example:
9642 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9643 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
9644 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009645 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009647req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
9648rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
9649 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
9650 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
9651 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
9652 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
9653 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
9654 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
9655 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009657 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
9658 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
9659 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9660 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
9661 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
9662 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009664 ACL derivatives :
9665 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009667 Example :
9668 listen tse-farm
9669 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9670 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9671 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9672 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9673 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9674 persist rdp-cookie
9675 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9676 # This is only useful makes sense if
9677 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9678 stick-table type string size 204800
9679 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9680 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9681 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009683 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
9684 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009686req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
9687rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
9688 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
9689 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
9690 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
9691 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009693 ACL derivatives :
9694 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009696req.ssl_hello_type : integer
9697req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
9698 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
9699 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
9700 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
9701 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
9702 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
9703 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
9704 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009706req.ssl_sni : string
9707req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
9708 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
9709 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
9710 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
9711 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
9712 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
9713 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
9714 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
9715 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
9716 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
9717 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
9718 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
9719 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009721 ACL derivatives :
9722 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009724 Examples :
9725 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
9726 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9727 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
9728 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
9729 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009731res.ssl_hello_type : integer
9732rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
9733 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
9734 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
9735 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
9736 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
9737 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
9738 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
9739 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02009740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009741req.ssl_ver : integer
9742req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
9743 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
9744 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
9745 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
9746 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
9747 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
9748 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
9749 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
9750 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
9751 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009753 ACL derivatives :
9754 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009756res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
9757 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
9758 in the response buffer.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009760res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
9761 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9762 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9763 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
9764 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009766 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009768wait_end : boolean
9769 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
9770 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
9771 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
9772 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
9773 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
9774 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
9775 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
9776 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009778 Examples :
9779 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
9780 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
9781 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009783 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
9784 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
9785 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
9786 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
9787 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
9788 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
9789 tcp-request content reject
9790
9791
97927.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
9793--------------------------------------
9794
9795It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
9796This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
9797data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
9798its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
9799HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
9800content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
9801to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
9802more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
9803response are indexed.
9804
9805base : string
9806 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
9807 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
9808 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
9809 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
9810 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9811 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
9812 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
9813 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
9814
9815 ACL derivatives :
9816 base : exact string match
9817 base_beg : prefix match
9818 base_dir : subdir match
9819 base_dom : domain match
9820 base_end : suffix match
9821 base_len : length match
9822 base_reg : regex match
9823 base_sub : substring match
9824
9825base32 : integer
9826 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
9827 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
9828 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
9829 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
9830
9831base32+src : binary
9832 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
9833 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
9834 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
9835 per-URL counters.
9836
9837req.cook([<name>]) : string
9838cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
9839 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
9840 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
9841 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
9842 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
9843 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
9844 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
9845 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
9846 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9847
9848 ACL derivatives :
9849 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
9850 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
9851 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
9852 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
9853 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
9854 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
9855 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
9856 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009858req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
9859cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
9860 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
9861 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009863req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
9864cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
9865 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
9866 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
9867 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
9868 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009870cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
9871 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
9872 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
9873 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
9874 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
9875 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9876 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
9877 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
9878 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
9879 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
9880 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009882hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
9883 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
9884 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
9885 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
9886 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
9887 unambiguouslly apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009889req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
9890 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
9891 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
9892 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
9893 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
9894 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
9895 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
9896 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
9897 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009899req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
9900 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
9901 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
9902 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
9903 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009905req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
9906 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
9907 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
9908 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
9909 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
9910 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
9911 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
9912 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
9913 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
9914 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
9915 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
9916 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009918 ACL derivatives :
9919 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
9920 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
9921 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
9922 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
9923 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
9924 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
9925 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
9926 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
9927
9928req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
9929hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
9930 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
9931 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
9932 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
9933 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
9934 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
9935 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
9936 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
9937 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
9938 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
9939
9940req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
9941hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
9942 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
9943 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
9944 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
9945 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
9946 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9947 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9948 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
9949 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
9950
9951req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
9952hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
9953 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
9954 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
9955 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
9956 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
9957 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
9958 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
9959 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
9960
9961http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
9962 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
9963 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
9964 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
9965 basic auth is supported.
9966
9967http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group
9968 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
9969 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist, and
9970 whether that username belongs to one of the groups supplied in ACL patterns.
9971 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
9972 basic auth is supported.
9973
9974 ACL derivatives :
9975 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : user group match
9976
9977http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02009978 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
9979 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009980 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
9981 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02009982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009983method : integer + string
9984 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
9985 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
9986 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
9987 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
9988 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
9989 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
9990 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009992 ACL derivatives :
9993 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009995 Example :
9996 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
9997 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
9998 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010000path : string
10001 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10002 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10003 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10004 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10005 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10006 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10007 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010009 ACL derivatives :
10010 path : exact string match
10011 path_beg : prefix match
10012 path_dir : subdir match
10013 path_dom : domain match
10014 path_end : suffix match
10015 path_len : length match
10016 path_reg : regex match
10017 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010019req.ver : string
10020req_ver : string (deprecated)
10021 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10022 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10023 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010025 ACL derivatives :
10026 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010028res.comp : boolean
10029 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10030 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10031 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010033res.comp_algo : string
10034 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10035 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10036 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010038res.cook([<name>]) : string
10039scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10040 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10041 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10042 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010044 ACL derivatives :
10045 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010047res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10048scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10049 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10050 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10051 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010053res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10054scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10055 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10056 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10057 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010059res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10060 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10061 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10062 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10063 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10064 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10065 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10066 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10067 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10068 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010070res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10071 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10072 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10073 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10074 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10075 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010077res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10078shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10079 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10080 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10081 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10082 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10083 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10084 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10085 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10086 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010088 ACL derivatives :
10089 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10090 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10091 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10092 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10093 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10094 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10095 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10096 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10097
10098res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10099shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10100 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10101 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10102 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10103 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10104 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010106res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10107shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10108 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10109 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10110 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10111 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10112 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10113 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010115res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10116shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10117 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10118 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10119 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10120 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10121 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10122 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010124res.ver : string
10125resp_ver : string (deprecated)
10126 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
10127 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010129 ACL derivatives :
10130 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010132set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10133 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10134 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
10135 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
10136 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010138 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
10139 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010141 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010143status : integer
10144 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
10145 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
10146 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010148url : string
10149 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
10150 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
10151 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
10152 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
10153 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
10154 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
10155 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010157 ACL derivatives :
10158 url : exact string match
10159 url_beg : prefix match
10160 url_dir : subdir match
10161 url_dom : domain match
10162 url_end : suffix match
10163 url_len : length match
10164 url_reg : regex match
10165 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010167url_ip : ip
10168 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
10169 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
10170 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
10171 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
10172 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
10173 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10174 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010176url_port : integer
10177 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
10178 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
10179 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10180 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010182urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10183url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10184 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
10185 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
10186 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
10187 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
10188 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
10189 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
10190 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
10191 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
10192 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010194 ACL derivatives :
10195 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
10196 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
10197 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
10198 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
10199 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
10200 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
10201 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
10202 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010203
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010205 Example :
10206 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
10207 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
10208 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
10209 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010211urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
10212 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
10213 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
10214 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020010215
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010010216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200102177.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010218---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010220Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
10221every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010222order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010224ACL name Equivalent to Usage
10225---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010226FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010227HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010228HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
10229HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010230HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
10231HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
10232HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
10233HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
10234LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010235METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
10236METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
10237METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
10238METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
10239METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
10240METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010241RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010242REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010243TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010244WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
10245---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010246
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010247
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102488. Logging
10249----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010250
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010251One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
10252provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
10253very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
10254provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
10255state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010256to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010257headers.
10258
10259In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
10260about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
10261send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
10262
10263 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
10264 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
10265 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
10266 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
10267 at the termination.
10268
10269The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
10270allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
10271as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
10272while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
10273real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
10274delay.
10275
10276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102778.1. Log levels
10278---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010279
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010280TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010281source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010282HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
10283in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
10284track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
10285syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
10286about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010287
10288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102898.2. Log formats
10290----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010291
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010292HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010293and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
10294slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
10295options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010296
10297 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
10298 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
10299 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
10300 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
10301 extents.
10302
10303 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
10304 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
10305 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
10306 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
10307 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
10308
10309 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
10310 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
10311 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
10312 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
10313 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
10314
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010315 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
10316 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
10317 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
10318 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
10319
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010320 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
10321
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010322Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
10323specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
10324field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
10325servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
10326always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
10327identifier.
10328
10329Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
10330 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
10331 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
10332 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
10333 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
10334
10335
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103368.2.1. Default log format
10337-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010338
10339This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
10340as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
10341format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
10342
10343 Example :
10344 listen www
10345 mode http
10346 log global
10347 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10348
10349 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
10350 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
10351 (www/HTTP)
10352
10353 Field Format Extract from the example above
10354 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
10355 2 'Connect from' Connect from
10356 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
10357 4 'to' to
10358 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
10359 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
10360
10361Detailed fields description :
10362 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
10363 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
10364 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
10365 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
10366 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10367 and processed the connection.
10368 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
10369
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010370In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
10371"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
10372connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
10373
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010374It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
10375will eventually disappear.
10376
10377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103788.2.2. TCP log format
10379---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010380
10381The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
10382is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
10383information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
10384counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
10385emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
10386environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
10387the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
10388sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010389specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
10390not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
10391fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
10392marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010393
10394 Example :
10395 frontend fnt
10396 mode tcp
10397 option tcplog
10398 log global
10399 default_backend bck
10400
10401 backend bck
10402 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10403
10404 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
10405 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
10406 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
10407
10408 Field Format Extract from the example above
10409 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
10410 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
10411 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
10412 4 frontend_name fnt
10413 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
10414 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
10415 7 bytes_read* 212
10416 8 termination_state --
10417 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
10418 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10419
10420Detailed fields description :
10421 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010422 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10423 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10424 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10425 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10426 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010427
10428 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010429 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10430 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10431 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010432
10433 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
10434 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
10435 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
10436 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
10437
10438 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10439 and processed the connection.
10440
10441 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10442 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10443 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
10444 applications.
10445
10446 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10447 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10448 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10449 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
10450 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
10451
10452 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10453 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10454 See "Timers" below for more details.
10455
10456 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10457 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10458 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
10459 "Timers" below for more details.
10460
10461 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10462 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10463 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10464 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10465 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10466 details.
10467
10468 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
10469 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
10470 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
10471 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
10472 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
10473
10474 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10475 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10476 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
10477 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
10478 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
10479 for more details.
10480
10481 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010482 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010483 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
10484 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
10485 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010486 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010487
10488 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10489 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10490 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10491 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10492 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10493 caused by a denial of service attack.
10494
10495 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10496 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10497 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10498 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10499 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10500 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10501 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10502 denial of service attack.
10503
10504 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10505 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10506 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10507 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10508 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10509 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10510 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10511 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
10512 be processed than on other servers.
10513
10514 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10515 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10516 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10517 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10518 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10519 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10520 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10521 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10522 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10523 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10524 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10525 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10526 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10527
10528 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10529 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10530 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10531 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10532 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10533 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10534 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10535 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10536
10537 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10538 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10539 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10540 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10541 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10542 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10543 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10544 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10545 occurs.
10546
10547
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105488.2.3. HTTP log format
10549----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010550
10551The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
10552is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
10553the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
10554are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
10555emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
10556generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
10557"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
10558which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010559frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
10560is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010561
10562Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
10563slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
10564with a star ('*') after the field name below.
10565
10566 Example :
10567 frontend http-in
10568 mode http
10569 option httplog
10570 log global
10571 default_backend bck
10572
10573 backend static
10574 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10575
10576 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10577 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10578 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010579 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010580
10581 Field Format Extract from the example above
10582 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
10583 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
10584 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
10585 4 frontend_name http-in
10586 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
10587 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
10588 7 status_code 200
10589 8 bytes_read* 2750
10590 9 captured_request_cookie -
10591 10 captured_response_cookie -
10592 11 termination_state ----
10593 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
10594 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10595 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
10596 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
10597 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010598
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010599
10600Detailed fields description :
10601 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010602 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10603 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10604 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10605 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10606 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010607
10608 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010609 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10610 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10611 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010612
10613 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
10614 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
10615 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
10616 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
10617 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
10618
10619 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10620 and processed the connection.
10621
10622 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10623 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10624 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
10625
10626 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10627 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10628 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10629 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
10630 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
10631 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
10632
10633 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
10634 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
10635 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
10636 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
10637 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
10638 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
10639
10640 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10641 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10642 See "Timers" below for more details.
10643
10644 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10645 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10646 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
10647 below for more details.
10648
10649 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
10650 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
10651 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
10652 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
10653 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
10654 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
10655 for more details.
10656
10657 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10658 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10659 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10660 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10661 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10662 details.
10663
10664 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
10665 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
10666 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
10667
10668 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
10669 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
10670 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
10671 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
10672 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
10673 overflowing.
10674
10675 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
10676 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
10677 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
10678 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
10679 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
10680 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
10681 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
10682 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10683
10684 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
10685 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
10686 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
10687 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
10688 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
10689 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
10690 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
10691 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10692
10693 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10694 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10695 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
10696 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
10697 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
10698 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
10699 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
10700
10701 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010702 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010703 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
10704 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
10705 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010706 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010707 system.
10708
10709 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10710 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10711 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10712 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10713 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10714 caused by a denial of service attack.
10715
10716 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10717 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10718 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10719 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10720 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10721 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10722 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10723 denial of service attack.
10724
10725 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10726 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10727 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10728 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10729 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10730 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10731 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10732 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
10733 processed than on other servers.
10734
10735 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10736 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10737 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10738 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10739 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10740 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10741 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10742 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10743 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10744 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10745 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10746 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10747 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10748
10749 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10750 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10751 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10752 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10753 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10754 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10755 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10756 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10757
10758 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10759 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10760 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10761 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10762 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10763 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10764 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10765 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10766 occurs.
10767
10768 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10769 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10770 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10771 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10772 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10773 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10774 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10775 cookies" below for more details.
10776
10777 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10778 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10779 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10780 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10781 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10782 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10783 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10784 and cookies" below for more details.
10785
10786 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10787 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10788 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10789 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10790 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10791 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10792 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10793 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10794
10795
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200107968.2.4. Custom log format
10797------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010798
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010799The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010800mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010801
10802HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10803Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10804separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10805prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10806
10807Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10808variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10809string formats ("Q").
10810
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010010811If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010812as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010010813less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
10814the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
10815
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010816Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10817HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10818
10819Flags are :
10820 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010821 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010822
10823 Example:
10824
10825 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10826 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10827
10828At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10829
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010830 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
10831 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010832
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010833the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010834
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010835 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010836 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010837 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010838
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010839and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10840
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010841 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010842 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10843
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010844Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10845
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010846 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010847 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010848 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10849 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10850 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010851 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
10852 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
10853 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010854 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010855 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010856 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010857 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010858 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010859 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010860 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10861 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010862 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010863 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10864 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010865 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010866 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10867 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010868 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10869 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
10870 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010871 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010872 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
10873 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010874 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010875 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10876 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
10877 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010878 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010879 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10880 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10881 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10882 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010883 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010884 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010885 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010886 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010887 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010888 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010889 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
10890 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
10891 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010892 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010893 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10894 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010895 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010896 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010897 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010898 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010899
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010900 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010901
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010010902
109038.2.5. Error log format
10904-----------------------
10905
10906When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
10907protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
10908By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
10909"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
10910will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
10911logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
10912
10913The format looks like this :
10914
10915 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
10916 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
10917 Connection error during SSL handshake
10918
10919 Field Format Extract from the example above
10920 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
10921 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
10922 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
10923 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
10924 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
10925
10926These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
10927failures.
10928
10929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109308.3. Advanced logging options
10931-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010932
10933Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
10934just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
10935options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
10936for more information about their usage.
10937
10938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109398.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
10940------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010941
10942It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
10943haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
10944commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
10945monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
10946ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
10947
10948 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
10949 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
10950 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
10951 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
10952
10953 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
10954 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
10955 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
10956 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
10957 such as other load-balancers.
10958
10959 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
10960 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
10961 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
10962
10963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109648.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
10965----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010966
10967The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
10968what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
10969or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
10970"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
10971just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
10972log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
10973after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
10974is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
10975with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
10976with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
10977
10978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109798.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
10980------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010981
10982Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
10983for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
10984"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
10985retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
10986raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
10987a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
10988file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
10989you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
10990"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
10991
10992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109938.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
10994--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010995
10996Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
10997multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
10998them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
10999"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11000logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11001error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11002and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11003too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11004useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11005alternative.
11006
11007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110088.4. Timing events
11009------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011010
11011Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11012reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11013the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11014frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11015mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11016
11017 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11018 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11019 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11020 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11021 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11022
11023 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11024 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11025 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11026 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11027 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11028
11029 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11030 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11031 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11032 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11033 connection never established.
11034
11035 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11036 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11037 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11038 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11039 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11040 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11041 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11042 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11043 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11044 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11045 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11046
11047 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11048 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11049 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11050 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
11051 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
11052
11053 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11054
11055 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11056 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11057 negative.
11058
11059These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11060protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11061that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011062due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011063close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11064session has been aborted on timeout.
11065
11066Most common cases :
11067
11068 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11069 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11070 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11071 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11072 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11073 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11074 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11075 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11076 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011077 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11078 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11079 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011080
11081 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11082 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11083 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11084 of ms on remote networks.
11085
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011086 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11087 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11088 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011089
11090 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11091 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11092 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11093 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11094 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11095 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11096 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11097 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11098 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11099 to the server until another one is released.
11100
11101Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11102
11103 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11104 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11105 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11106
11107 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11108 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11109 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11110
11111 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11112 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11113 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11114 flags.
11115
11116 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11117 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11118 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11119 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11120 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11121 the client connection was maintained open.
11122
11123 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
11124 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
11125 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
11126 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
11127
11128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111298.5. Session state at disconnection
11130-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011131
11132TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
11133"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
111342-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
11135each of which has a special meaning :
11136
11137 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
11138 session to terminate :
11139
11140 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
11141
11142 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
11143 server explicitly refused it.
11144
11145 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
11146 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
11147 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
11148 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011149 (eg: cacheable cookie).
11150
11151 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
11152 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011153
11154 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
11155 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
11156 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
11157 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
11158 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
11159
11160 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
11161 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
11162 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
11163 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
11164 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
11165
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090011166 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
11167 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
11168
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011169 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
11170 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
11171 backup connections when going up.
11172
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020011173 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
11174
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011175 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
11176 send or receive data.
11177
11178 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
11179 send or receive data.
11180
11181 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
11182 with nothing left in the buffers.
11183
11184 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
11185
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010011186 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011187 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
11188
11189 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
11190 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
11191 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
11192 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
11193 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
11194
11195 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
11196 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
11197
11198 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
11199 server (HTTP only).
11200
11201 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
11202
11203 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
11204 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
11205 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
11206
11207 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
11208 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
11209 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
11210
11211 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
11212
11213 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
11214 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
11215
11216 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
11217 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
11218 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
11219
11220 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
11221 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020011222 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
11223 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011224
11225 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
11226 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
11227 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
11228 another server.
11229
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011230 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011231 server.
11232
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011233 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
11234 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
11235 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
11236 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11237
11238 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
11239 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
11240 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
11241 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11242
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020011243 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
11244 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
11245 "use-server" rule).
11246
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011247 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11248
11249 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
11250 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
11251
11252 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
11253
11254 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
11255 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
11256 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
11257
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011258 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
11259 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
11260 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
11261 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
11262 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
11263
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011264 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
11265
11266 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
11267 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
11268
11269 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
11270
11271 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11272
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011273The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
11274was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011275helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
11276starvation, attacks, etc...
11277
11278The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
11279alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
11280easier finding and understanding.
11281
11282 Flags Reason
11283
11284 -- Normal termination.
11285
11286 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
11287 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
11288 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
11289 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
11290
11291 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
11292 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
11293 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
11294 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
11295 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
11296 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011297
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011298 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11299 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011300 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011301
11302 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
11303 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
11304 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
11305
11306 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
11307 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
11308 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
11309 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
11310 the server takes too long to respond.
11311
11312 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
11313 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
11314 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
11315 long a time to respond.
11316
11317 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
11318 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
11319 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
11320 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
11321 and the client.
11322
11323 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
11324 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
11325 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
11326 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
11327 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
11328 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
11329
11330 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
11331 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011332 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
11333 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
11334 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
11335 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011336
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011337 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
11338 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
11339
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011340 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011341 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
11342 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
11343 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
11344 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
11345 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
11346
11347 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
11348 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
11349 503 or 504 here.
11350
11351 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
11352 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
11353 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
11354 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
11355 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
11356
11357 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11358 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011359 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011360 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
11361 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
11362
11363 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
11364 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
11365 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
11366 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
11367 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
11368 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
11369 between haproxy and the server.
11370
11371 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
11372 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
11373 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
11374 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
11375 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
11376 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
11377 solution is to fix the application.
11378
11379 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
11380 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
11381 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
11382 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
11383 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
11384 external attacks.
11385
11386 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
11387 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011388 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011389 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
11390 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
11391
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011392 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
11393 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
11394 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
11395 the client.
11396
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011397 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
11398 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
11399 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
11400 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011401 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
11402 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
11403 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
11404 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
11405 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011406
11407 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
11408 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
11409 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
11410 returned an HTTP 403 error.
11411
11412 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
11413 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
11414 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
11415 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
11416
11417 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
11418 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
11419 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
11420 only be solved by proper system tuning.
11421
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011422The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
11423persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
11424important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
11425re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
11426
11427 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
11428
11429 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11430 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
11431 set on a GET request.
11432
11433 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
11434 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011435 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011436 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
11437
11438 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
11439 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
11440 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
11441
11442 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11443 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
11444 already got a cookie.
11445
11446 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11447 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
11448 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
11449 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
11450 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
11451
11452 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11453 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11454 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11455
11456 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
11457 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11458 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11459
11460 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
11461 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
11462
11463 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
11464 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
11465 then advertised in the response.
11466
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114688.6. Non-printable characters
11469-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011470
11471In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
11472consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
11473converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
11474prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
11475being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
11476escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
11477is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
11478'}' when logging headers.
11479
11480Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
11481issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
11482containing spaces is "User-Agent".
11483
11484Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
11485the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
11486performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
11487
11488
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114898.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
11490---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011491
11492Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
11493achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011494section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011495cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
11496the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
11497the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011498locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011499not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
11500user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
11501a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
11502wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
11503
11504 Examples :
11505 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
11506 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
11507
11508 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
11509 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
11510
11511
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
11513---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011514
11515Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
11516proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
11517the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
11518server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
11519
11520Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
11521response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011522section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011523
11524It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011525time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
11526appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011527are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
11528and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
11529follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
11530request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
11531in the logs.
11532
11533 Example :
11534 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
11535 listen proxy-out
11536 mode http
11537 option httplog
11538 option logasap
11539 log global
11540 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
11541
11542 # log the name of the virtual server
11543 capture request header Host len 20
11544
11545 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
11546 capture request header Content-Length len 10
11547
11548 # log the beginning of the referrer
11549 capture request header Referer len 20
11550
11551 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
11552 capture response header Server len 20
11553
11554 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
11555 capture response header Content-Length len 10
11556
11557 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
11558 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
11559
11560 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
11561 capture response header Via len 20
11562
11563 # log the URL location during a redirection
11564 capture response header Location len 20
11565
11566 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
11567 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
11568 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11569 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
11570 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
11571
11572 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11573 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11574 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11575 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011576 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011577
11578 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11579 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11580 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11581 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
11582 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011583 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011584
11585
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115868.9. Examples of logs
11587---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011588
11589These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
11590them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
11591reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
11592
11593 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
11594 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11595 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11596
11597 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
11598 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
11599
11600 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
11601 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
11602 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11603
11604 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
11605 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
11606
11607 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
11608 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11609 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
11610
11611 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011612 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011613 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
11614 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
11615
11616 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
11617 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
11618 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
11619
11620 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
11621 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011622 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011623 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
11624 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
11625 to return the 502 and not the server.
11626
11627 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011628 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011629
11630 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
11631 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
11632 Nothing was sent to any server.
11633
11634 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
11635 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
11636
11637 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
11638 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
11639 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
11640 send a 408 return code to the client.
11641
11642 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
11643 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
11644
11645 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
11646 5 seconds ("c----").
11647
11648 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
11649 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011650 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011651
11652 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011653 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011654 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
11655 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
11656 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
11657 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
11658 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011659
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116619. Statistics and monitoring
11662----------------------------
11663
11664It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
11665mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
11666CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
11667Unix socket.
11668
11669
116709.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011671---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011672
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010011673The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
11674page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
11675
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011676 0. pxname: proxy name
11677 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
11678 for server)
11679 2. qcur: current queued requests
11680 3. qmax: max queued requests
11681 4. scur: current sessions
11682 5. smax: max sessions
11683 6. slim: sessions limit
11684 7. stot: total sessions
11685 8. bin: bytes in
11686 9. bout: bytes out
11687 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011688 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011689 12. ereq: request errors
11690 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011691 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011692 15. wretr: retries (warning)
11693 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010011694 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011695 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
11696 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
11697 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
11698 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
11699 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
11700 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
11701 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
11702 25. qlimit: queue limit
11703 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
11704 27. iid: unique proxy id
11705 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
11706 29. throttle: warm up status
11707 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
11708 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020011709 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020011710 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
11711 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
11712 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011713 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011714 UNK -> unknown
11715 INI -> initializing
11716 SOCKERR -> socket error
11717 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
11718 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
11719 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
11720 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
11721 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
11722 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11723 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11724 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
11725 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
11726 disable-on-404
11727 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11728 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11729 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011730 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
11731 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011732 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
11733 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
11734 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
11735 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
11736 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
11737 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011738 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
11739 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
11740 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
11741 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011742 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
11743 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010011744 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
11745 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
11746 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010011747 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011748
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117509.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011751-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011752
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011753The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011754must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
11755is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
11756a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
11757risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
11758followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
11759given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
11760then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
11761to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011762
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011763It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
11764on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
11765own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011766
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011767clear counters
11768 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
11769 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
11770 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
11771 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
11772 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11773
11774clear counters all
11775 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
11776 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
11777 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
11778
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011779clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
11780 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
11781
11782 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
11783 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
11784 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
11785 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
11786 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
11787 later after the session ends is usual enough.
11788
11789 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
11790
11791 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
11792 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
11793 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
11794 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11795 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11796 the ACLs :
11797
11798 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11799 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11800 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11801 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11802 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11803 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11804
11805 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011806 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
11807 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011808
11809 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011810 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011811 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011812 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11813 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11814 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11815 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011816
11817 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11818
11819 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011820 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011821 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11822 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011823 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11824 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11825 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011826
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011827disable frontend <frontend>
11828 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11829 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11830 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11831 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11832 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11833 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11834 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11835 on the stats page.
11836
11837 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11838 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11839
11840 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11841 level "admin".
11842
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011843disable server <backend>/<server>
11844 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11845 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11846 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11847 during the maintenance.
11848
11849 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
11850 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
11851
11852 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011853 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011854
11855 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11856 level "admin".
11857
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011858enable frontend <frontend>
11859 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
11860 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
11861 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
11862 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
11863 which was disabled.
11864
11865 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11866 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11867
11868 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11869 level "admin".
11870
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011871enable server <backend>/<server>
11872 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
11873 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
11874
11875 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011876 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011877
11878 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11879 level "admin".
11880
11881get weight <backend>/<server>
11882 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
11883 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
11884 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
11885 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
11886 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011887 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011888
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011889help
11890 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
11891 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011892
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011893prompt
11894 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
11895 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
11896 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
11897 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
11898 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
11899 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
11900 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
11901 command.
11902
11903quit
11904 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011905
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011906set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020011907 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
11908 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
11909 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
11910 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
11911 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011912 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
11913 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11914
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020011915set maxconn global <maxconn>
11916 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
11917 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
11918 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
11919 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
11920 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
11921 setting.
11922
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020011923set rate-limit connections global <value>
11924 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
11925 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
11926 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
11927 is passed in number of connections per second.
11928
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011929set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
11930 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
11931 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010011932 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
11933 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011934
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020011935set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
11936 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
11937 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
11938 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
11939 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
11940 IP address or affect its quality of service.
11941
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011942set timeout cli <delay>
11943 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
11944 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
11945 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
11946
11947set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
11948 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
11949 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090011950 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
11951 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
11952 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
11953 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
11954 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
11955 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
11956 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
11957 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
11958 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
11959 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
11960 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
11961 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
11962 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011963
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011964show errors [<iid>]
11965 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
11966 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011967 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
11968 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
11969 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011970
11971 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
11972 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
11973 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
11974 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
11975 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
11976 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
11977 are reported too.
11978
11979 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
11980 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
11981 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
11982 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
11983 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
11984 code.
11985
11986 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
11987 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
11988 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
11989 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
11990 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
11991 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
11992 line.
11993
11994 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011995 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11996 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011997 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
11998 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
11999
12000 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
12001 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
12002 00038 Location: blah\r\n
12003 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
12004 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
12005 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
12006 00204+ minal\r\n
12007 00211 \r\n
12008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012009 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012010 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
12011 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
12012 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
12013 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
12014 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
12015 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012016
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012017show info
12018 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
12019
12020show sess
12021 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012022 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
12023 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12024
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010012025show sess <id>
12026 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
12027 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12028 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
12029 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
12030 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010012031 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
12032 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
12033 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012034
12035show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
12036 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
12037 possible to dump only selected items :
12038 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
12039 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
12040 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
12041 for example:
12042 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
12043 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
12044 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
12045
12046 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012047 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
12048 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012049 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
12050 Release_date: 2009/09/23
12051 Nbproc: 1
12052 Process_num: 1
12053 (...)
12054
12055 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
12056 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
12057 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
12058 (...)
12059 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
12060
12061 $
12062
12063 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
12064 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
12065 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
12066 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012067 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012068
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012069show table
12070 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
12071 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
12072 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
12073 entries currently in use.
12074
12075 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012076 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012077 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
12078 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012079
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012080show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012081 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
12082 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
12083 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012084 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
12085
12086 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
12087 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
12088 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
12089 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
12090 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
12091
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012092 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12093 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12094 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12095 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12096 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12097 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12098
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012099
12100 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012101 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
12102 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012103
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012104 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012105 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012106 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012107 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12108 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12109 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12110 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012111
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012112 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012113 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012114 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12115 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012116
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012117 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
12118 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012119 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012120 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12121 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012122
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012123 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
12124 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012125 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012126 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12127 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
12128
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012129 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
12130 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
12131 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
12132 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
12133 time goes, the average event rate drops.
12134
12135 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
12136 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
12137 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012138 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
12139 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012140 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
12141 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020012142
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012143shutdown frontend <frontend>
12144 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
12145 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
12146 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
12147 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
12148 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
12149 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
12150 once it is terminated.
12151
12152 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12153 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12154
12155 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12156 level "admin".
12157
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020012158shutdown session <id>
12159 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
12160 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12161 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
12162 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
12163 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
12164 flag in the logs.
12165
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020012166shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
12167 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
12168 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
12169 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
12170 'K' flag in the logs.
12171
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012172/*
12173 * Local variables:
12174 * fill-column: 79
12175 * End:
12176 */